Samsung Clx 6220 User Manual

CLX-6220 Series  
CLX-6250 Series  
Multi-Functional Printer  
User’s Guide  
imagine the possibilities  
Thank you for purchasing a Samsung product.  
safety information  
These warnings and precautions are included in order to prevent injury to you and others, as well as preventing any  
potential damage to your machine. Be sure to read and understand all of these instructions before using the machine.  
Use common sense for operating any electrical appliance and whenever using your machine. Also, follow all warnings and  
instructions marked on the machine and in the accompanying literature. After reading this section, keep it in a safe place  
for future reference.  
Important safety symbols  
This section explains the meanings of all icons and signs in the user's guide. These safety symbols are in order, according to the degree of  
danger.  
Explanation of all icons and signs used in the user’s guide:  
Warning  
Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in severe personal injury or death.  
Caution  
Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in minor personal injury or property damage.  
Do not attempt.  
Do not disassemble.  
Do not touch.  
Unplug the power cord from the wall socket.  
Make sure the machine is grounded to prevent electric shock.  
Call the service center for help.  
Follow directions explicitly.  
Operating environment  
Warning  
Do not use if the power cord is damaged or if the  
electrical outlet is not grounded.  
Do not bend, or place heavy objects on the power  
cord.  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
Stepping on or allowing the power cord to be  
crushed by a heavy object could result in electric  
shock or fire.  
Do not place anything on top of the machine (water,  
small metal or heavy objects, candles, lit cigarettes,  
etc.).  
Do not remove the plug by pulling on the cord; do not  
handle the plug with wet hands.  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
Safety information_ 1  
If the machine gets overheated, it releases smoke,  
makes strange noises, or generates an odd odor,  
immediately turn off the power switch and unplug the  
machine.  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
Caution  
During an electrical storm or for a period of  
non-operation, remove the power plug from the  
electrical outlet.  
If the plug does not easily enter the electrical outlet, do not  
attempt to force it in.  
Call an electrician to change the electrical outlet, or this  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
could result in electric shock.  
Be careful, the paper output area is hot.  
Do not allow pets to chew on the AC power, telephone or PC  
interface cords.  
Burns could occur.  
This could result in electric shock or fire and/or injury to your  
pet.  
If the machine has been dropped, or if the cabinet appears  
damaged, unplug the machine from all interface connections  
and request assistance from qualified service personnel.  
If the machine does not operate properly after these  
instructions have been followed, unplug the machine from all  
interface connections and request assistance from qualified  
service personnel.  
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.  
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.  
If the machine exhibits a sudden and distinct change in  
performance, unplug the machine from all interface  
connections and request assistance from qualified service  
personnel.  
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.  
Operating method  
Caution  
Do not forcefully pull the paper out during printing.  
When printing large quantities, the bottom part of the  
paper output area may get hot. Do not allow children  
to touch.  
It can cause damage to the machine.  
Children may be burned.  
Be careful not to put your hand between the machine  
and paper tray.  
When removing jammed paper, do not use tweezers  
or sharp metal objects.  
You may get injured.  
It can cause damage to the machine.  
Do not block or push objects into the ventilation opening.  
Do not allow too many papers to stack up in the paper output  
tray.  
This could result in elevated component temperatures which  
can cause damage or fire.  
It could cause damage to the machine.  
Use care to avoid paper cuts when replacing paper or removing  
jammed paper.  
This machine's power interception device is the power cord.  
To switch off the power supply, remove the power cord from  
You may get hurt.  
the electrical outlet.  
Safety information_ 2  
Installation / Moving  
Warning  
Do not place the machine in an area with dust,  
humidity or water leaks.  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
Caution  
When moving the machine, turn the power off and  
disconnect all cords; then lift the machine with at  
least two people.  
Do not put a cover over the machine or place it in an airtight  
location, such as a closet.  
If the machine is not well-ventilated, this could result in fire.  
The machine could fall, causing human injury or  
machine damage.  
Do not place the machine on an unstable surface.  
Make sure you plug the power cord into a grounded electrical  
outlet.  
The machine could fall, causing human injury or machine  
damage.  
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.  
The machine should be connected to  
Do not overload wall outlets and extension cords.  
the power level which is specified on the label.  
This can diminish performance, and could result in electric  
shock or fire.  
If you are unsure and want to check the power level you are  
using, contact the electrical utility company.  
Use only No.26 AWGa or larger, telephone line cord, if  
necessary.  
Use the power cord supplied with your machine for safe  
operation. If you are using a cord which is longer than 2 meters  
(79”) with a 140V machine, then the gauge should be 16 AWG  
or larger.  
Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine.  
Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine, and could  
result in electric shock or fire.  
a. AWG: American Wire Gauge  
Maintenance / Checking  
Caution  
Unplug this product from the wall outlet before  
Keep cleaning supplies away from children.  
cleaning the inside of the machine. Do not clean the  
machine with benzene, paint thinner or alcohol; do  
not spray water directly into the machine.  
Children may get hurt.  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
When you are working inside the machine replacing  
supplies or cleaning the inside, do not operate the  
machine.  
Do not disassemble, repair or rebuild the machine by  
yourself.  
It can cause damage to the machine. Call a  
You may get injured.  
certified technician when the machine needs repair.  
Safety information_ 3  
Keep the power cable and the contact surface of the plug clean  
from dust or water.  
To clean and operate the machine, strictly follow the user's  
guide provided with the machine.  
This could result in electric shock or fire.  
Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine.  
Do not remove any covers or guards that are fastened with  
screws.  
The machine should only be repaired by Samsung service  
technician.  
Supply usage  
Caution  
Do not disassemble the toner cartridge.  
When storing supplies such as toner cartridges, keep  
them away from children.  
Toner dust can be dangerous to humans.  
Toner dust can be dangerous to humans.  
Do not burn any of the supplies such as toner  
cartridge or fuser unit.  
Using recycled supplies, such as toner, can cause damage to  
the machine.  
It can cause an explosion or fire.  
In case of damage due to the use of recycled supplies, a  
service fee will be charged.  
When changing the toner cartridge or removing jammed paper,  
be careful not to let toner dust touch your body or clothes.  
Toner dust can be dangerous to humans.  
Safety information_ 4  
regulatory information  
This machine is certified with several regulatory statements.  
Laser Safety Statement  
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, chapter 1 Subchapter J for Class I(1) laser products, and  
elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1:1993 + A1:1997 + A2:2001.  
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and printer are designed so there is never any human access to  
laser radiation above a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance or prescribed service condition.  
Wavelenght: 800 nm  
Beam divergence  
-
-
Paraller: 11 degrees  
Perpendicular: 35 degrees  
Maximum power or energy output: 12 mW  
WARNING  
Never operate or service the printer with the protective cover removed from Laser/Scanner assembly. The reflected beam, although invisible,  
can damage your eyes.  
When using this product, these basic safety precautions should always be followed to reduce risk of fire, electric shock, and injury to persons:  
Taiwan only  
Regulatory information_ 1  
Ozone Safety  
During normal operation, this machine produces ozone. The ozone produced does not present a hazard to the operator. However, it is  
advisable that the machine be operated in a well ventilated area.  
If you need additional information about ozone, request your nearest Samsung dealer.  
Mercury Safety  
Contains Mercury, Dispose According to Local, State or Federal Laws. (U.S.A. only)  
Power Saver  
This printer contains advanced energy conservation technology that reduces power consumption when it is not in active use.  
When the printer does not receive data for an extended period of time, power consumption is automatically lowered.  
ENERGY STAR and the ENERGY STAR mark are registered U.S. marks.  
Recycling  
China only  
Recycle or dispose of the packaging material for this product in an environmentally responsible manner.  
Regulatory information_ 2  
Correct Disposal of This Product (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment)  
(Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate collection systems)  
This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB  
cable) should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or  
human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate these items from other types of waste and recycle them responsibly to  
promote the sustainable reuse of material resources.  
Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and  
how they can take these items for environmentally safe recycling.  
Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product and its electronic  
accessories should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for disposal.  
Correct disposal of batteries in this product  
(Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate battery return systems.)  
This marking on the battery, manual or packaging indicates that the batteries in this product should not be disposed of with other household  
waste at the end of their working life. Where marked, the chemical symbols Hg, Cd or Pb indicate that the battery contains mercury, cadmium  
or lead above the reference levels in EC Directive 2006/66. If batteries are not properly disposed of, these substances can cause harm to  
human health or the environment.  
To protect natural resources and to promote material reuse, please separate batteries from other types of waste and recycle them through your  
local, free battery return system.  
Radio Frequency Emissions  
FCC Information to the User  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These  
limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses  
and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to  
radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause  
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to  
try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or experienced radio TV technician for help.  
Change or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to  
operate the equipment.  
Canadian Radio Interference Regulations  
This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class A limits for radio noise emissions from digital apparatus as set out in the interference-causing  
equipment standard entitled “Digital Apparatus”, ICES-003 of the Industry and Science Canada.  
Cet appareil numérique respecte les limites de bruits radioélectriques applicables aux appareils numériques de Classe A prescrites dans la  
norme sur le matériel brouilleur: “Appareils Numériques”, ICES-003 édictée par l’Industrie et Sciences Canada.  
Regulatory information_ 3  
UNITED STATES OF AMERICA  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC)  
Intentional emitter per FCC Part 15  
Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz Band, may be  
present (embedded) in your printer system. This section is only applicable if these devices are present. Refer to the system label to verify the  
presence of wireless devices.  
Wireless devices that may be in your system are only qualified for use in the United States of America if an FCC ID number is on the system  
label.  
The FCC has set a general guideline of 20 cm (8 inches) separation between the device and the body, for use of a wireless device near the  
body (this does not include extremities). This device should be used more than 20 cm (8 inches) from the body when wireless devices are on.  
The power output of the wireless device (or devices), which may be embedded in your printer, is well below the RF exposure limits as set by  
the FCC.  
This transmitter must not be collocated or operation in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.  
Operation of this device is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must  
accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.  
Wireless devices are not user serviceable. Do not modify them in any way. Modification to a wireless device will void the authorization to  
use it. Contact manufacturer for service.  
FCC Statement for Wireless LAN use:  
While installing and operating this transmitter and antenna combination the radio frequency exposure limit of 1m W/cm2 may be  
exceeded at distances close to the antenna installed. Therefore, the user must maintain a minimum distance of 20cm from the antenna at  
all times. This device cannot be colocated with another transmitter and transmitting antenna.  
Taiwan only  
Turkey only  
Regulatory information_ 4  
Russia only  
Fax Branding  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other electronic device to send any  
message via a telephone facsimile machine unless such message clearly contains in a margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or  
on the first page of the transmission the following information:  
1. the date and time of transmission  
2. identification of either business, business entity or individual sending the message; and  
3. telephone number of either the sending machine, business, business entity or individual.  
The Telephone Company may make changes in its communications facilities, equipment operations or procedures where such action is  
reasonably required in the operation of its business and is not inconsistent with the rules and regulations in FCC Part 68. If such changes can  
be reasonably expected to render any customer terminal equipment incompatible with telephone company communications facilities, or require  
modification or alteration of such terminal equipment, or otherwise materially affect its use or performance, the customer shall be given  
adequate notice in writing, to allow the customer an opportunity to maintain uninterrupted service  
Ringer Equivalence Number  
The Ringer Equivalence Number and FCC Registration Number for this machine may be found on the label located on the bottom or rear of the  
machine. In some instances you may need to provide these numbers to the telephone company.  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is a measure of the electrical load placed on the telephone line, and is useful for determining whether  
you have “overloaded” the line. Installing several types of equipment on the same telephone line may result in problems making and receiving  
telephone calls, especially ringing when your line is called. The sum of all Ringer Equivalence Numbers of the equipment on your telephone  
line should be less than five in order to assure proper service from the telephone company. In some cases, a sum of five may not be usable on  
your line. If any of your telephone equipment is not operating properly, you should immediately remove it from your telephone line, as it may  
cause harm to the telephone network.  
The equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the ACTA. On the rear of this equipment is a label that  
contains, among other information, a product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided to the  
telephone company.  
FCC Regulations state that changes or modifications to this equipment not expressly approved by the manufacturer could void the user’s  
authority to operate this equipment. In the event that terminal equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company  
should notify the customer that service may be stopped. However, where prior notice is impractical, the company may temporarily cease  
service, providing that they:  
a)promptly notify the customer.  
b)give the customer an opportunity to correct the equipment problem.  
c)inform the customer of the right to bring a complaint to the Federal Communication Commission pursuant to procedures set out in FCC  
Rules and Regulations Subpart E of Part 68.  
Regulatory information_ 5  
You should also know that:  
Your machine is not designed to be connected to a digital PBX system.  
If you intend to use a computer modem or fax modem on the same phone line as your machine, you may experience transmission and  
reception problems with all the equipment. It is recommended that no other equipment, except for a regular telephone, share the line with  
your machine.  
If your area experiences a high incidence of lightning or power surges, we recommend that you install surge protectors for both the power  
and the telephone lines. Surge protectors can be purchased from your dealer or telephone and electronic specialty stores.  
When programming emergency numbers and/or making test calls to emergency numbers, use a non-emergency number to advise the  
emergency service dispatcher of your intentions. The dispatcher will give you further instructions on how to actually test the emergency  
number.  
This machine may not be used on coin service or party lines.  
This machine provides magnetic coupling to hearing aids.  
You may safely connect this equipment to the telephone network by means of a standard modular jack, USOC RJ-11C.  
Replacing the Fitted Plug (for UK Only)  
Important  
The mains lead for this machine is fitted with a standard (BS 1363) 13 amp plug and has a 13 amp fuse. When you change or examine the  
fuse, you must re-fit the correct 13 amp fuse. You then need to replace the fuse cover. If you have lost the fuse cover, do not use the plug until  
you have another fuse cover.  
Contact the people from you purchased the machine.  
The 13 amp plug is the most widely used type in the UK and should be suitable. However, some buildings (mainly old ones) do not have normal  
13 amp plug sockets. You need to buy a suitable plug adaptor. Do not remove the moulded plug.  
If you cut off the moulded plug, get rid of it straight away.  
You cannot rewire the plug and you may receive an electric shock if you plug it into a socket.  
Important warning:  
You must earth this machine.  
The wires in the mains lead have the following color code:  
Green and Yellow: Earth  
Blue: Neutral  
Brown: Live  
If the wires in the mains lead do not match the colors marked in your plug, do the following:  
You must connect the green and yellow wire to the pin marked by the letter “E” or by the safety ‘Earth symbol’ or colored green and yellow or  
green.  
You must connect the blue wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “N” or colored black.  
You must connect the brown wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “L” or colored red.  
You must have a 13 amp fuse in the plug, adaptor, or at the distribution board.  
Regulatory information_ 6  
Declaration of Conformity (European Countries)  
Approvals and Certifications  
The CE marking applied to this product symbolizes Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Declaration of Conformity with the following applicable  
93/68/EEC Directives of the European Union as of the dates indicated:  
Hereby, Samsung Electronics declare that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of:  
R&TTE Directive (1999/5/EC)  
The declaration of conformity may be consulted at www.samsung.com/printer, go to Support > Download center and enter your printer (MFP)  
name to browse the EuDoC.  
January 1, 1995: Council Directive 2006/95/EC Approximation of the laws of the member states related to low voltage equipment.  
January 1, 1996: Council Directive 2004/108/EC (92/31/EEC), approximation of the laws of the Member States related to electromagnetic  
compatibility.  
March 9, 1999: Council Directive 1999/5/EC on radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment and the mutual recognition of  
their conformity. A full declaration, defining the relevant Directives and referenced standards can be obtained from your Samsung Electronics  
Co., Ltd. representative.  
EC Certification  
Certification to 1999/5/EC Radio Equipment & Telecommunications Terminal Equipment Directive (FAX)  
This Samsung product has been self-certified by Samsung for pan-European single terminal connection to the analogue public switched  
telephone network (PSTN) in accordance with Directive 1999/5/EC. The product has been designed to work with the national PSTNs and  
compatible PBXs of the European countries:  
In the event of problems, you should contact the Euro QA Lab of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. in the first instance.  
The product has been tested against TBR21. To assist in the use and application of terminal equipment which complies with this standard, the  
European Telecommunication Standards Institute (ETSI) has issued an advisory document (EG 201 121) which contains notes and additional  
requirements to ensure network compatibility of TBR21 terminals. The product has been designed against, and is fully compliant with, all of the  
relevant advisory notes contained in this document.  
European Radio Approval Information (for products fitted with EU-approved radio devices)  
Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz band, may be  
present (embedded) in your printer system which is intended for home or office use. This section is only applicable if these devices are present.  
Refer to the system label to verify the presence of wireless devices.  
Wireless devices that may be in your system are only qualified for use in the European Union or associated areas if a CE mark with a Notified  
Body Registration Number and the Alert Symbol is on the system label.  
The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in you printer is well below the RF exposure limits as set by the  
European Commission through the R&TTE directive.  
European States qualified under wireless approvals:  
EU  
Austria, Belgium, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France (with frequency restrictions), Germany, Greece,  
Hungary, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Lithuania, Luxembourg, Malta, The Netherlands, Poland, Portugal, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain,  
Sweden and the U.K.  
EEA/EFTA  
countries  
Iceland, Liechtenstein, Norway and Switzerland  
European States with restrictions on use:  
EU  
In France, the frequency range is restricted to 2446.5-2483.5 MHz for devices above 10 mW transmitting power such as  
wireless  
In Italiy, if used outside of own premises, general authorization is required  
In Russian, only for indoor applications  
EEA/EFTA  
countries  
No limitations at this time.  
Regulatory information_ 7  
REGULATORY COMPLIANCE STATEMENTS  
Wireless Guidance  
Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz Band, may be  
present (embedded) in your printer system. The following section is a general overview of considerations while operating a wireless device.  
Additional limitations, cautions, and concerns for specific countries are listed in the specific country sections (or country group sections). The  
wireless devices in your system are only qualified for use in the countries identified by the Radio Approval Marks on the system rating label. If  
the country you will be using the wireless device in, is not listed, contact your local Radio Approval agency for requirements. Wireless devices  
are closely regulated and use may not be allowed.  
The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in your printer is well below the RF exposure limits as known at this  
time. Because the wireless devices (which may be embedded into your printer) emit less energy than is allowed in radio frequency safety  
standards and recommendations, manufacturer believes these devices are safe for use. Regardless of the power levels, care should be taken  
to minimize human contact during normal operation.  
As a general guideline, a separation of 20 cm (8 inches) between the wireless device and the body, for use of a wireless device near the body  
(this does not include extremities) is typical. This device should be used more than 20 cm (8 inches) from the body when wireless devices are  
on and transmitting.  
This transmitter must not be collocated or operation in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.  
Some circumstances require restrictions on wireless devices. Examples of common restrictions are listed below:  
Radio frequency wireless communication can interfere with equipment on commercial aircraft. Current aviation regulations require  
wireless devices to be turned off while traveling in an airplane. IEEE 802.11 (also known as wireless Ethernet) and Bluetooth  
communication devices are examples of devices that provide wireless communication.  
In environments where the risk of interference to other devices or services is harmful or perceived as harmful, the option to use a wireless  
device may be restricted or eliminated. Airports, Hospitals, and Oxygen or flammable gas laden atmospheres are limited examples where  
use of wireless devices may be restricted or eliminated. When in environments where you are uncertain of the sanction to use wireless  
devices, ask the applicable authority for authorization prior to use or turning on the wireless device.  
Every country has different restrictions on the use of wireless devices. Since your system is equipped with a wireless device, when  
traveling between countries with your system, check with the local Radio Approval authorities prior to any move or trip for any restrictions  
on the use of a wireless device in the destination country.  
If your system came equipped with an internal embedded wireless device, do not operate the wireless device unless all covers and  
shields are in place and the system is fully assembled.  
Wireless devices are not user serviceable. Do not modify them in any way. Modification to a wireless device will void the authorization to  
use it. Contact manufacturer for service.  
Only use drivers approved for the country in which the device will be used. See the manufacturer System Restoration Kit, or contact  
manufacturer Technical Support for additional information.  
OpenSSL License  
Copyright (c) 1998-2001 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment: "This product includes  
software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)."  
4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without  
prior written permission. For written permission, please contact openssl-core@openssl.org.  
5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written  
permission of the OpenSSL Project.  
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the  
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)".  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,  
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,  
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF  
Regulatory information_ 8  
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND  
ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)  
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young(eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson  
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).  
Original SSLeay License  
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved.  
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). The implementation was written so as to conform with  
Netscapes SSL.  
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to  
all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with this  
distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). Copyright remains Eric Young's,  
and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given  
attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation  
(online or textual) provided with the package.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement: "This product includes  
cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)" The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the library  
being used are not cryptographic related.  
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application code) you must include an  
acknowledgement: "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)".  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG “AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN  
NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,  
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;  
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,  
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF  
THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply  
be copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.  
Regulatory information_ 9  
China only  
Regulatory information_ 10  
about this user’s guide  
This user’s guide provides information about how to use the machine. Both novice and professional users can refer to this  
as a guide for installing and using the machine.  
Read the safety information before using the machine.  
If you have a problem using the machine, refer to the troubleshooting chapter (See "Troubleshooting" on page 1).  
Terms used in this user’s guide are explained in the glossary chapter (See "Glossary" on page 1).  
All illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on its options or models.  
The procedures in this user’s guide are mainly based on Windows XP.  
Convention  
Some terms in this guide are used interchangeably, as below:  
Document is synonymous with original.  
Paper is synonymous with media, or print media.  
Machine refers to printer or MFP.  
The following table offers the conventions of this guide:  
Convention  
Description  
Example  
Bold  
Note  
For texts on the display or button names on the machine.  
Start  
Provides additional information or detailed specification of the machine function  
and feature.  
The date format may differ from country  
to country.  
Caution  
Gives users information to protect the machine from possible mechanical  
damage or malfunction.  
Do not touch the green surface of the  
toner cartridge.  
Footnote  
Provides additional more detailed information on certain words or a phrase.  
Guides users to a reference page for the additional detailed information.  
a. pages per minute  
(“Cross-reference”)  
About this user’s guide_ 1  
Finding more information  
You can find information for setting up and using your machine from the following resources, either as a print-out or on screen.  
Material name  
Description  
This guide provides basic information on setting up your machine.  
Quick Install Guide  
User’s Guide  
Driver Help  
This guide provides you with step-by-step instructions for using your machine’s full features, and contains information for maintaining  
your machine, troubleshooting and replacing supplies.  
This help provides you with help information on printer driver and instructions for setting up the options for printing (See "Using help" on  
page 3).  
Samsung website  
If you have Internet access, you can get help, support, machine drivers, manuals, and order information from the Samsung website,  
Downloadable  
software  
You can download useful software from the Samsung website.  
XPS printer driver: used to print documents in XPS print path. XPS printer driver can be installed only on Windows Vista or higher.  
About this user’s guide_ 2  
 
features of your new product  
Your new machine is equipped with a number of special features that improve the quality of the documents you print.  
Special Features  
Print with excellent quality and speed  
* Zoran IPS Emulation compatible with PostScript 3:  
You can print in a full range of colors using cyan, magenta,  
yellow, and black.  
You can print with a resolution of up to 9,600 x 600 dpi  
effective output.  
CLX-6220 Series prints up to 20 ppm, A4-sized paper or up  
to 21 ppm, letter sized paper.  
CLX-6250 Series prints up to 24 ppm, A4-sized paper or up  
to 25 ppm, letter sized paper.  
©Copyright 1995-2005, Zoran Corporation. All rights reserved.  
Zoran, the Zoran logo, IPS/PS3, and OneImage are trademarks  
of Zoran Corporation.  
136 PS3 fonts: Contains UFST and MicroType from  
Monotype Imaging Inc.  
Print in various environments  
You can print with various operating system such as  
Windows, Linux, Macintosh and UNIX systems (See  
Your machine is equipped with a USB interface and a  
network interface.  
Handle many different types of printable material  
The multi-purpose tray supports envelopes, labels,  
custom-sized media, postcards, and heavy paper.  
The tray 1 and optional tray support plain paper in various  
Copy originals in several formats  
Your machine can copy multiple image copies from the  
original document on a single page (See "2-up or 4-up  
The print quality and image size may be adjusted and  
enhance at the same time.  
Create professional documents (Windows only)  
Print Watermarks. You can customize your documents with  
words, such as “Confidential” (See "Using watermarks" on  
page 5).  
Print Posters. The text and pictures of each page of your  
document are magnified and printed across the sheet of  
paper and can then be taped together to form a poster (See  
Scan the originals and send it right away  
Scan in color and use the precise compressions of JPEG,  
TIFF and PDF formats.  
Quickly scan and send files to multiple destinations using  
Networks scanning (See "Sending a scanned image to  
You can use preprinted forms with plain paper (See"Using  
Save time and money  
To save paper, you can print multiple pages on one single  
This machine automatically conserves electricity by  
substantially reducing power consumption when not in use.  
To save paper, you can print on both sides of the paper  
(double-sided printing) (See "Printing on both sides of paper"  
Set a specific time to transmit a Fax  
You can specify a certain time to transmit the fax and also  
send the fax to several stored destinations.  
After the transmission, the machine may print out the fax  
reports according to the setting.  
Use USB flash memory devices  
Expand your machine’s capacity  
If you have a USB memory device, you can use it in various  
ways with your machine.  
Your machine has an extra memory slot to expand the  
Zoran IPS Emulation* compatible with PostScript 3 (PS)  
enables PS printing.  
You can scan documents and save them to the device.  
You can directly print data stored to the device.  
Features of your new product_ 1  
IPv6  
This machine supports IPv6.  
Features by Models  
The machine is designed to support all of your document needs from printing and copying to more advanced networking solutions for your business.  
Some features and optional goods may not be available depending on models or countries.  
Features by models include:  
FEATURES  
CLX-6220 Series  
CLX-6250 Series  
USB 2.0  
USB Memory Interface  
Document Feeder  
Hard Disk  
Network Interface Ethernet 10/100 BaseTX wired LAN  
Network Interface 802.11 b/g wireless LANa  
Duplex (2-sided) printing  
FAX  
Optional Tray 2  
a.Depending on your country, wireless LAN cards may not be available. Contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer  
where you bought your printer.  
( : Included, : Optional, Blank: Not available)  
Features of your new product_ 2  
1.  
introduction  
This chapter gives you an overview of your machine:  
This chapter includes:  
Machine overview  
Front view  
Optional tray 2a  
Scanner glass  
Scan unit  
9
20  
21  
Document feeder cover  
Front door  
1
2
3
4
12  
13  
14  
15  
Document feeder width  
guides  
Tray 1  
10  
Document output tray  
Control panel  
Inner cover of the reverse  
unit.  
Multi-purpose tray  
11  
22  
Document feeder input tray  
Document feeder output tray  
Multi-purpose tray paper  
width guides  
a.Optional device.  
USB memory port  
Toner cartridges  
Paper transfer belt  
Scanner lid  
5
6
7
8
16  
17  
18  
19  
Front door handle  
Multi-purpose tray handle  
Paper level indicator  
Scanner lock switch  
Introduction_ 1  
   
Rear view  
Extension telephone socket  
(EXT)  
Control board cover  
1
7
Rear door  
Telephone line socket  
2
3
4
5
6
8
Cable organizer  
Power receptacle  
Power-switch  
Handle  
Optional tray 2 cable connector  
9
Network port  
USB port  
10  
11  
12  
IEEE 802.11 b/g Wireless LANa  
a.Optional device.  
Introduction_ 2  
 
Control panel overview  
You can copy both sides of an ID Card such as a driver’s license to a single side of paper (See "ID card copying" on page 2).  
ID Copy  
1
2
Allows you to directly print files stores on a USB memory device when it is inserted into the USB memory port on your  
Direct USB  
Allows you to print documents on both sides of the paper.  
Shows the current status and prompts during an operation.  
Show the status of each toner cartridge.  
Duplex  
3
4
Display screen  
Toner colors  
Status  
5
Shows the status of your machine (See "Understanding the Status LED" on page 5).  
Activates fax mode.  
6
Fax  
7
Copy  
Activates copy mode.  
Activates scan mode.  
8
Scan/Email  
9
Confirms the selection on the screen.  
OK  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
Arrow  
Scroll through the options available in the selected menu, and increase or decrease values.  
Enters Menu mode and scrolls through the available menus (See "Machine status and advanced feature" on page 1).  
Sends you back to the upper menu level.  
Menu  
Back  
Numeric keypad  
Dials fax number, and enters the number value for document copies or other options.  
Allows you to store frequently used fax numbers and email addresses or search for stored fax numbers or email addresses.  
Address  
Book  
15  
In standby mode, redials the last number. Also in edit mode, inserts a pause into a fax number.  
Enable you dial a number with the receiver on the hook.  
Redial/Pause  
On Hook Dial  
16  
17  
Stops an operation at any time. The pop-up window appears on the screen showing the current job that the user can stop or  
resume.  
Stop/Clear  
18  
19  
Sends the machine into power saver mode. If you press and hold this button, you can also turn the power on and off (See  
Power Saver  
Introduction_ 3  
 
Starts a job in black or color mode.  
Start  
20  
Introduction_ 4  
Understanding the Status LED  
Introducing the useful buttons  
Menu button  
The color of the Status indicates the machine's current status.  
Status  
Description  
The machine is off-line.  
Off  
Green Blinking  
When you want to know the machine status and set your machine to use an  
advanced feature, click Menu button (See "Machine status and advanced  
When the backlight slowly blinks, the machine  
is receiving data from the computer.  
When the backlight blinks rapidly, the  
machine is printing data.  
Stop/Clear button  
On  
Blinking  
The machine is on-line and can be used.  
Red  
A minor error has occurred and the machine is  
waiting for the error to be cleared. Check the  
display message. When the problem is  
cleared, the machine resumes.  
By pressing the  
, you can:  
Function  
Description  
during printing.  
A small amount of toner is left in the cartridge.  
The estimated cartridge lifea of toner is close.  
Prepare a new cartridge for replacement. You  
may temporarily increase the printing quality  
by redistributing the toner (See "Replacing the  
Cancel print job  
Press  
Power Saver button  
On  
A toner cartridge has almost reached its  
estimated cartridge lifea. It is recommended to  
replace the toner cartridge (See "Replacing  
When the machine is not in use, save electricity by pressing the Power  
Saver button. Pressing this button for one second puts the machine into  
power save mode (See "Using the power saving mode" on page 3).  
A paper jam has occurred (See "Clearing  
If you press this button for more than three seconds, a pop-up appears,  
asking if you want to turn the power off. If you choose Yes, the power is  
turned off. This button must then be used to turn the button on.  
The cover is opened. Close the cover.  
There is no paper in the tray. Load paper in  
the tray.  
The machine has stopped due to a major  
error. Check the display message (See  
page 8).  
Status  
Description  
Off  
The machine is not in the power save mode.  
The machine is in the power save mode.  
Blue  
On  
In the following cases, the machine wakes up from the power save  
mode.  
Data is received.  
Front door or scan unit is opened.  
Control panel key is pressed.  
Power-switch turn the power on and off.  
a.Estimated cartridge life means the expected or estimated toner  
cartridge life, which indicates the average capacity of print-outs and is  
designed pursuant to ISO/IEC 19798. The number of pages may be  
affected by operating environment, printing interval, graphics, media  
type and media size. Some amount of toner may remain in the cartridge  
even when Replace new [ccc] toner appears and the printer stops  
printing.  
Samsung does not recommend using non-genuine Samsung toner  
cartridge such as one that is refilled or remanufactured. Samsung  
cannot guarantee a non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge's quality.  
Service or repair required as a result of using non-genuine Samsung  
toner cartridges will not be covered under the machine warranty.  
All printing errors will be appear in the Smart Panel program window.  
If the problem persists, call for service.  
Check the message on the display screen. Follow the instructions in  
the message or refer to troubleshooting part (See "Understanding  
display messages" on page 8). If the problem persists, call for  
service.  
Introduction_ 5  
       
1.  
getting started  
This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the USB connected machine and software.  
This chapter includes:  
2. Unpack the machine and check all the enclosed items.  
3. Remove all the tapes.  
Setting up the hardware  
This section shows the steps to set up the hardware, as is explained in the  
Quick Install Guide. Make sure you read the Quick Install Guide first and  
follow the steps below:  
4. Install the toner cartridges.  
6. Make sure that all cables are connected to the machine.  
7. Turn the machine on.  
1. Select a stable location.  
Select a level, stable place with adequate space for air circulation. Allow  
extra space to open covers and trays.  
This equipment will be inoperable when mains power fails.  
The area should be well ventilated and away from direct sunlight or  
sources of heat, cold, and humidity. Do not set the machine close to the  
edge of your desk or table.  
Printing a demo page  
Print a demo page to make sure that the machine is operating correctly.  
To print a demo page:  
In ready mode, press and hold the OK for about 3 seconds, then release.  
Supplied software  
After you have set up your machine and connected it to your computer, you  
must install the printer software. If you are a Windows or Macintosh OS,  
UNIX OS user, download the software from the Samsung website  
(www.samsung.com/printer) and install.  
Machine software are occasionally updated due to release of new  
operating system and etc. If needed, download the latest version from  
the Samsung website. (www.samsung.com/printer)  
Printing is suitable for altitudes under 1,000 m (3,281 ft). Refer to the  
altitude setting to optimize your printing (See "Altitude adjustment" on  
page 1).  
Place the machine on a flat, stable surface so that there is no incline  
greater than 2 cm (0.79 inch). Otherwise, printing quality may be  
affected.  
Getting started_ 1  
     
a.Allows you to edit a scanned image in various ways using a powerful  
image editor and to send the image by email. You can also open another  
image editor program, such as Adobe Photoshop, from SmarThru Office.  
For details, refer to the on screen help supplied on the SmarThru Office  
program (See "Smarthru Office" on page 3).  
OS  
Contents  
Windows  
Printer driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of  
your machine’s features.  
PostScript Printer Driver: Use the PostScript driver to  
print documents with complex fonts and graphics in the PS  
language. (PostScript printer description file is included.)  
Scanner driver: TWAIN and Windows Image Acquisition  
(WIA) drivers are available for scanning documents on  
your machine.  
Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the  
machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs  
during printing.  
SmarThru Officea: This program is the accompanying  
System requirements  
Before you begin, ensure that your system meets the following  
requirements:  
Microsoft® Windows®  
Your machine supports the following Windows operating systems.  
Windows-based software for your multifunctional machine.  
Requirement (recommended)  
OPERATING  
Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: You can find out  
about scan and fax manager program information and  
installed scan driver's condition.  
free HDD  
space  
SYSTEM  
CPU  
RAM  
Samsung Network PC Fax: You can find out about fax  
manager program information. You can send a fax from  
your computer without going to the machine.  
Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set  
up printer’s other options from your computer desktop.  
Direct Printing Utility (CLX-6250 Series only): This  
program allows you to print PDF files directly.  
SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP  
addresses.  
Windows® 2000 Intel® Pentium® II 400  
64 MB  
(128 MB)  
600 MB  
MHz (Pentium III 933  
MHz)  
Windows® XP  
Intel® Pentium® III 933  
MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz)  
128 MB  
(256 MB)  
1.5 GB  
Windows  
Server® 2003  
Intel® Pentium® III 933  
MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz)  
128 MB  
(512 MB)  
1.25 GB to  
2 GB  
Windows  
Server® 2008  
Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 512 MB  
10 GB  
15 GB  
16 GB  
Macintosh  
PostScript Printer Driver: Use this driver to run your  
machine from a Macintosh computer and print documents.  
(PostScript printer description file is included.)  
Scanner driver: TWAIN driver and Image Capture driver  
are available for scanning documents on your machine.  
Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the  
machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs  
during printing.  
Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: You can find out  
about scan and fax manager program information and  
installed scan driver's condition.  
(Pentium IV 2 GHz)  
(2048 MB)  
Windows  
Vista®  
Intel® Pentium® IV 3 GHz 512 MB  
(1024 MB)  
Windows® 7  
Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 1 GB (2  
32-bit or 64-bit processor  
or higher  
GB)  
Support for DirectX® 9 graphics with 128 MB memory  
(to enable the Aero theme).  
DVD-R/W Drive  
Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set  
up printer’s other options from your computer desktop.  
SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP  
addresses.  
Windows  
Server® 2008  
R2  
Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 512 MB  
10 GB  
(x86) or 1.4 GHz (x64)  
processors (2 GHz or  
faster)  
(2048 MB)  
Linux  
Unified Linux Driver: Use this driver to take full  
advantage of your machine’s features.  
PostScript Printer Driver: Use this driver to run your  
machine from a Linux computer and print documents.  
(PostScript printer description file is included.)  
Internet Explorer® 5.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for all  
Windows operating systems.  
Administrator rights are required to install the software.  
Windows Terminal Services is compatible with this machine.  
SANE: Use this driver to scan documents.  
Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the  
machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs  
during printing.  
Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set  
up printer’s other options from your computer desktop.  
SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP  
addresses.  
UNIX  
UNIX Printer Driver: Use this driver to print documents  
from the UNIX system.  
Getting started_ 2  
   
Macintosh  
Installing USB connected machine’s driver  
A locally connected machine is a machine directly attached to your  
computer using the USB cable. If your machine is attached to a network,  
skip the following steps below and go on to installing network connected  
page 3).  
Requirements (recommended)  
RAM  
OPERATING  
SYSTEM  
free HDD  
space  
CPU  
Intel  
Mac OS X  
10.3 ~ 10.4  
128 MB for a  
PowerPC based  
Mac (512 MB)  
512 MB for a  
Intel-based Mac  
(1 GB)  
1 GB  
Only use an USB cable no longer then 3 m (10 ft. ).  
Processors  
PowerPC G4/  
G5  
Windows  
You can install the machine software using the typical or custom method.  
The following steps below are recommended for most users who use a  
machine directly connected to your computer. All components necessary for  
machine operations will be installed.  
Mac OS X  
10.5  
Intel  
512 MB (1 GB)  
1 GB  
1 GB  
Processors  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
867 MHz or  
faster Power  
PC G4/ G5  
on.  
If the “Found New Hardware Wizard” window appears during the  
installation procedure, click Cancel in close the window.  
Mac OS X  
10.6  
Intel  
1 GB (2 GB)  
Processors  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
The software CD should automatically run and an installation window  
appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive. Click OK.  
Linux  
Item  
Requirement (recommended)  
Operating  
system  
RedHat® Enterprise Linux WS 4, 5 (32/64 bit)  
Fedora Core 2~10 (32/64 bit)  
If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2  
click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run.  
SuSE Linux 9.1 (32 bit)  
Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive and click OK.  
OpenSuSE® 9.2, 9.3, 10.0, 10.1, 10.2, 10.3, 11.0,  
11.1 (32/64 bit)  
Mandrake 10.0, 10.1 (32/64 bit)  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 and  
Windows 2008 Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account  
Control windows.  
Mandriva 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 (32/64 bit)  
Ubuntu 6.06, 6.10, 7.04, 7.10, 8.04, 8.10 (32/64 bit)  
SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 9, 10 (32/64 bit)  
Debian 3.1, 4.0, 5.0 (32/64 bit)  
3. Select Install now.  
CPU  
RAM  
Pentium IV 2.4 GHz (Intel Core™2)  
512 MB (1024 MB)  
Free HDD space  
1 GB (2 GB)  
It is necessary to claim swap partition of 300 MB or larger for working  
with large scanned images.  
The Linux scanner driver supports the optical resolution at maximum.  
UNIX  
Item  
Requirements  
Sun Solaris / SPARC  
Sun Solaris / x86  
HP-UX / PA-RISC  
HP-UX / Itanium  
IBM AIX / Power  
Operating  
system  
If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
For CLX-6250 Series installation window, you can see Wireless  
Setting and Installation menu. You can use this menu if an  
optional wireless network card is installed and/or the machine  
is connected to your computer with a USB cable.  
Free HDD space  
Up to 100 MB  
Install the optional wireless network card. Instructions for  
Wireless Setting and Installation, refer to the wireless  
network installation guide provided with the optional wireless  
network card.  
The Advanced Installation has two options, Custom  
Getting started_ 3  
     
Installation and Install Software Only. The Custom  
Installation allows you to select the machine’s connection and  
choose individual components to install. The Install Software  
Only allows you to install the supplied software, such as Smart  
Panel. Follow the instruction in the window.  
operating system. Refer to the manual provided by  
individual programs.  
Direct Input  
The Direct Input allows you to search for a specific machine  
on the newtwork.  
-Search by IP address: Enter the IP address or the host  
Administrator Installation provides convenient installation  
methods useful for administrators (See "Administrator’s Guide  
name. Then click Next.  
To verify your machine’s IP address, print a network  
configuration report (See "Printing a machine report" on  
page 1).  
4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the  
License Agreement. Then, click Next.  
-Search by network path: To find a shared machine (UNC  
Path), enter the shared name manually or find a shared  
printer by clicking the Browse button. Then click Next.  
Help  
If your machine is not connected to the computer or network,  
This help button gives detailed information about the how to  
connect the machine.  
5. The searched machines will be shown on the screen. Select the one you  
want to use and click Next.  
When the driver finds only one machine, the confirmation window  
appears.  
6. After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page  
appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page.  
Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 8.  
7. If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes.  
If not, click No to reprint it.  
The program searches the machine.  
8. To register as a user of the machine in order to receive information from  
If your machine is not found in the network or locally, the following  
window will appear.  
Samsung, click On-line Registration.  
9. Click Finish.  
If the printer driver does not work properly, follow the steps below to  
repair or reinstall the driver.  
a)Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
b)From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs >  
Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Maintenance.  
c)Select the option you want, follow the instruction on the window.  
Macintosh  
The software CD that came with your machine provides you with the PPD  
file that allows you to use the CUPS driver or Apple LaserWriter driver (only  
available when you use a machine which supports the PostScript driver) for  
printing on a Macintosh computer.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
on.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
3. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop.  
4. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder.  
5. Double-click the Installer OS X icon.  
6. Enter the password and click OK.  
7. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue.  
8. Read the license agreement and click Continue.  
9. Click Agree to agree to the license agreement.  
10. Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for  
most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be  
installed.  
Check if you want to install the software without connecting  
the printer to the network or locally.  
-Check this option to install this program without a machine  
connected. In this case, the print a test page window will be  
skipped, and completes the installation.  
Search again  
When you press this button, the firewall notice window  
appears;  
-Turn off the firewall and Search again. For Window operating  
system, click Start > Control Panel > Windows Firewall,  
and inactivate this option. For other operating systems,  
refer to their guide.  
If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual components to  
-Turn off the firewall from the third party's program beside the  
Getting started_ 4  
   
install.  
administrator.  
11. When the message which warns that all applications will close on your  
computer appears, click Continue.  
12. Select Typical installation for a local printer and then click OK.  
3.From the Samsung website, download the Unified Linux Driver  
package to your computer.  
4.Right click the Unified Linux Driver package and extract the package.  
5.Double click cdroot > autorun.  
If you select Typical installation for a network printer during the  
machine driver installation, the SetIP program automatically runs.  
If the machine has already configured network infomation, close  
the SetIP program. Go to the next step.  
6.When the welcome screen appears, click Next.  
13. After the installation is finished, click Quit.  
14. Open the Applications folder > Utilities > Print Setup Utility.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, open the Applications folder > System  
Preferences and click Print & Fax.  
15. Click Add on the Printer List.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click the “+” icon; a display window will pop  
up.  
16. For Mac OS X 10.3, select the USB tab.  
For Mac OS X10.4, click Default Browser and find the USB  
connection.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click Default and find the USB connection.  
17. For Mac OS X 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
7.When the installation is complete, click Finish.  
Samsung in Printer Model and your machine name in Model Name.  
The installation program has added the Unified Driver Configurator  
desktop icon and the Unified Driver group to the system menu for your  
convenience. If you have any difficulties, consult the on screen help that  
is available through your system menu or can otherwise be called from  
the driver package Windows applications, such as Unified Driver  
Configurator or Image Manager.  
For Mac OS X 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Samsung in Print Using and your machine name in Model.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Select a driver to use... and your machine name in Print Using.  
Your machine appears on the Printer List, and is set as the default  
machine.  
Installing the SmartPanel  
18. Click Add.  
1.Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and  
reinstall it.  
Follow steps below to uninstall the driver for Macintosh.  
powered on.  
2.When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the  
Login field and enter the system password.  
a)Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
b)Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
c)Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop.  
d)Double-click the MAC_Installer folder.  
You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine  
software. If you are not a super user, ask your system  
administrator.  
3.From the Samsung website, download the Smart Panel package to  
your computer.  
e)Double-click the Installer OS X icon.  
4.Right click the Smart Panel package and extract the package.  
f)Enter the password and click OK.  
5.Double click cdroot > Linux > smartpanel > install.sh.  
g)The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue.  
h)Select Uninstall and click Uninstall.  
i)When the message which warns that all applications will close on  
your computer appears, Click Continue.  
j)When the uninstall is done, click Quit.  
Installing the Printer Setting Utility  
1.Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
2.When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the  
Login field and enter the system password.  
Linux  
You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine  
software. If you are not a super user, ask your system  
administrator.  
You need to download the Linux software package from the Samsung  
website to install the printer software.  
Follow the steps below to install the software.  
3.From the Samsung website, download the Printer Setting Utility  
Installing the Linux Unified Driver  
package to your computer.  
1.Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
4.Right click the Printer Setting Utility package and extract the  
powered on.  
package.  
2.When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the  
5.Double click cdroot > Linux > psu > install.sh.  
Login field and enter the system password.  
If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and  
reinstall it again.  
Follow the steps below to uninstall the driver for Linux.  
You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine  
software. If you are not a super user, ask your system  
Getting started_ 5  
   
a)Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
7.Check the Change Sharing Options.  
8.Check the Share this printer.  
b)When the Administrator Login window appears, type in “root”  
9.Fill in the Share Name field. Click OK.  
in the Login field and enter the system password.  
Setting up a client computer  
1.Install your printer driver (See "Installing USB connected machine’s  
You must log in as a super user (root) to uninstall the printer  
driver. If you are not a super user, ask your system  
administrator.  
c)Click the icon at the bottom of the desktop. When the Terminal  
screen appears, type in:  
[root@localhost root]#cd /opt/Samsung/mfp/uninstall/  
[root@localhost uninstall]#./uninstall.sh  
d)Click Uninstall.  
2.Click the Windows Start menu.  
3.Select All programs > Accessories > Window Explorer.  
4.Enter in the IP address of the host computer and press Enter.  
e)Click Next.  
f)Click Finish.  
In case host computer requires User name and Password, fill  
in User ID and password of the host computer account.  
5.Right click the printer icon you want to share and select Connect.  
6.When the set up complete message appears, click OK.  
7.Open the file you want to print and start printing.  
Sharing your machine locally  
Follow the steps below to set up the computers to share your machine  
locally.  
Macintosh  
If the Host computer is directly connected to the machine with a USB cable  
and is also connected to the local network environment, the client computer  
connected to the local network can use the shared machine through the  
host computer to print.  
The following steps are for Mac OS X 10.5~10.6. Refer to Mac Help  
for other OS versions.  
Setting up a host computer  
1.Install your printer driver (See "Macintosh" on page 4, "Macintosh" on  
page 5).  
2.Open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print  
& Fax.  
3.Select the printer to share in the Printer List.  
4.Select Share this printer.  
Setting up a client computer  
1.Install your printer driver (See "Installing USB connected machine’s  
2.Open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print  
Host computer  
A computer which is directly connected to  
the machine by USB cable.  
1
2
Client computers  
Computers which use the machine shared  
through the host computer.  
& Fax.  
3.Press the “+” icon.  
A display window showing the name of your shared printer appears.  
4.Select your machine and click Add.  
Windows  
Setting up a host computer  
1.Install your printer driver (See "Installing USB connected machine’s  
page 3).  
2.Click the Windows Start menu.  
3.For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and  
Sound > Printers.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Devices and Printers.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Devices and Printers.  
4.Right click your printer icon.  
5.For Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, press Properties.  
For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus,  
select the Printer properties.  
If Printer properties item has mark, you can select other  
printer drivers connected with selected printer.  
6.Select the Sharing tab.  
Getting started_ 6  
 
1.  
network setup  
This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the network connected machine and software.  
This chapter includes:  
SyncThru™ Web Service  
Web server embedded on your network machine, which allows you to:  
Network environment  
You need to set up the network protocols on the machine to use it as your  
network machine. You can set up the basic network settings through the  
machine's control panel.  
Configure the network parameters necessary for the machine to connect  
to various network environments.  
Customize machine settings.  
The following table shows the network environments supported by the  
machine:  
SyncThru™ Web Admin Service  
Item  
Requirements  
A web-based machine management solution for network administrators.  
SyncThru™ Web Admin Service provides you with an efficient way of  
network machines from any site with corporate internet access. Download  
this program from http://solution.samsungprinter.com.  
Network interface  
Ethernet 10/100 Base-TX  
802.11 b/g Wireless LAN (Optional)  
Network operating system  
Network protocols  
Windows  
2000/XP/2003/2008/Vista/7/2008  
Server R2  
Various Linux OS  
Mac OS X 10.3 ~ 10.6  
UNIX  
SetIP  
This utility program allows you to select a network interface and manually  
configure the IP addresses for use with the TCP/IP protocol (See "IPv4  
TCP/IPv4  
DHCP, BOOTP  
DNS, WINS, Bonjour, SLP, UPnP  
Standard TCP/IP Printing (RAW), LPR,  
IPP, WSD  
TCP/IPv6 is not supported by this program.  
Using a wired network  
SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP (S), Telnet, SMTP  
(S), LDAP (S), IPSec  
SMB, FTP, Kerberos  
TCP/IPv6 (DHCP, DNS, RAW, LPR,  
SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP (S), IPSec)  
You must set up the network protocols on your machine to use it on your  
network. This chapter will show you how this is easily accomplished.  
You can use network after connecting network cable to a corresponding  
port on your machine.  
Wireless security  
(Optional)  
Authentication: Open System, Shared  
Key, WPA Personal, WPA2 Personal  
(PSK)  
Encryption: WEP64, WEP128, TKIP,  
AES  
Introducing useful network programs  
Printing configuration report  
You can print a Network Configuration Report from the machine’s control  
panel that will show the current machine’s network settings. This will help  
you to set up a network and troubleshoot problems.  
There are several programs available to setup the network settings easily in  
network environment. For the network administrator especially, managing  
several machines on the network is possible.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Before using the programs below, set the IP address first.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Report and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Network Info. and press OK.  
Network setup_ 1  
     
5. Press OK when Yes highlights to confirm printing.  
Installing the program  
The Network Configuration Report prints.  
1.Insert the Printer Software CD-ROM provided with your machine.  
When the driver CD runs automatically, close that window.  
Using this Network Configuration Report, you can find your machine MAC  
address and IP address.  
2.Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer and open the X drive. (X  
represents your CD-ROM drive.)  
For example:  
3.Double-click Application > SetIP.  
4.Double-click Setup.exe to install this program.  
MAC Address : 00:15:99:41:A2:78  
IP Address : 192.0.0.192  
5.Click OK. If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
6.Follow the instructions in the window and complete the installation.  
Setting IPv4 address  
You must set up an IPv4 address for network printing and management. In  
most cases a new IP address will be automatically assigned by a DHCP  
(Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server located on the network.  
Starting the program  
1.Connect your machine and the computer using network cable.  
2.Turn on the machine.  
If you use IPv6 address, refer to "IPv6 Configuration" on page 6  
3.From the Windows Start menu, select All Programs > Samsung  
In a few situations the IP address must be set manually. This is called a  
static IP and is often required in corporate Intranets for security reasons.  
Printers > SetIP > SetIP.  
4.Click on the  
icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the  
DHCP IP assignment: Connect your machine to the network, and wait a  
few minutes for the DHCP server to assign an IP address to the  
machine. Then, print the Network Configuration Report as explained  
above. If the report shows that the IP address has changed, the  
assignment was successful. You will see the new IP address in the  
report.  
TCP/IP configuration window.  
5.Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as  
follows:  
Static IP assignment: Use the SetIP program to change the IP address  
from your computer. If your machine has a control panel, you can also  
change the IP address using the machine's control panel.  
In an office environment, we recommend that you contact a network  
administrator to set this address for you.  
IPv4 setting using control panel  
1.Connect your machine to the network with an network cable.  
2.Turn on the machine.  
3.Press Menu on the control panel.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Network and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight TCP/IP (IPv4) and press OK.  
6.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Static and press OK.  
7.Press the up/down arrow to highlight IP Address and press OK.  
8.Enter the IP address using numeric keypad and press OK.  
MAC Address : Find the machine’s MAC address on the Network  
Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For  
example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8.  
A MAC address is a hardware serial number of the machine’s  
network interface and can be found in the Network  
Configuration Report.  
9.Enter other parameters, such as the Subnet Mask and Gateway and  
press OK.  
IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer.  
10.After entering all parameters, press Stop/Clear to return to ready  
For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150,  
enter 192.168.1.X. (X is number between 1 and 254 other than  
the computer’s address.)  
mode.  
Subnet Mask: Enter a new Subnet Mask for your machine.  
Default Gateway: Enter a new Gateway for your machine.  
6.Click Apply, and then click OK. The machine will automatically print  
the Network Configuration Report. Confirm that all of the settings  
are correct.  
IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Windows)  
This program is for manually setting the network IP address of your  
machine using its MAC address to communicate with the machine. A  
MAC address is the hardware serial number of the network interface and  
can be found in the Network Configuration Report.  
For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing  
by performing the following:  
7.Click Exit to close the SetIP program.  
8.If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall.  
1.Open Control Panel.  
IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh)  
For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing  
by performing the following:  
2.Double click Security Center.  
3.Click Windows Firewall.  
4.Disable the firewall.  
The path and UIs may differ by Mac OS version. Refer to the Mac  
OS manul to turn firewall off.  
1.Open System Preferences.  
2.Click Security.  
Network setup_ 2  
   
3.Click the Firewall menu.  
4.Turn the firewall off.  
Restoring factory default settings using SyncThru™  
Web Service  
1.Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari or Firefox and  
The following instructions may vary for your model.  
enter your machine’s new IP address in the browser window.  
For example,  
Perform the following to configure the IP address:  
1.Connect your machine and the computer using network cable.  
2.Insert the Installation CD-ROM, and open the disk window. Open the  
MAC_Installer > MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPApplet.html.  
2.Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
3.Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service  
3.Double click the file and Safari will automatically open, then select  
Trust. The browser will open the SetIPApplet.html page that shows  
the printer’s name and IP address information.  
website.  
A log-in page appears.  
4.Click on the  
icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the  
4.Type in the ID and Password then click Login .  
TCP/IP configuration window.  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
5.Enter the printer’s new information into the configuration window as  
follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this  
information assigned by a network manager before proceeding.  
MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network  
Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For  
example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8.  
Password: sec00000  
5.When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Settings >  
Network Settings > Restore Default.  
6.Click Clear for network.  
7.Turn off and restart machine to apply settings.  
The MAC address is the hardware serial number of the  
on-board network interface and can be found on the  
Network Configuration Report.  
IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer.  
Installing network connected machine’s driver  
For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150,  
enter 192.168.1.X. (X is number between 1 and 254 other than  
the computer’s address.)  
You must install the printer driver software for printing. The software  
includes drivers, applications, and other user friendly programs.  
Subnet Mask: Enter a new Subnet Mask for your machine.  
Default Gateway: Enter a new Gateway for your machine.  
6.Select Apply, then OK, and OK again. The printer will automatically  
print the configuration report. Confirm that all of the settings are  
correct. Quit Safari. You may close and eject the installation  
CD-ROM. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. You have  
successfully changed the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway.  
Make sure that the network setup for your machine is completed. All  
applications should be closed on your computer before beginning  
installation.  
Windows  
This is recommended for most users. All components necessary for  
machine operations will be installed.  
Follow the steps below:  
IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Linux)  
The SetIP program should be automatically installed during the printer  
driver installation.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network and powered  
on.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
The path and UIs may differ by Linux OS version. Refer to the  
Linux OS manual to turn firewall off.  
The software CD should automatically run and an installation window  
appear.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive. Click OK.  
1.Print the machine’s network configuration report to find your machine’s  
MAC address.  
2.Open the /opt/Samsung/mfp/share/utils/.  
3.Double click the SetIPApplet.html file.  
4.Click to open the TCP/IP configuration window.  
5.Enter the MAC address, IP address, subnet mask, default gateway,  
If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2,  
click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive and click OK.  
and then click Apply.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 and  
Windows 2008 Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account  
Control windows.  
When you enter the MAC address, enter it without a colon(:).  
6.The machine prints the network information. Confirm all of the settings  
are correct.  
7.Close the SetIP program.  
Network parameter setting  
You can also set up the various network settings through the network  
administration programs such as SyncThru™ Web Admin Service and  
SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Network setup_ 3  
       
3. Select Install now.  
window will appear.  
If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
Check if you want to install the software without connecting  
For CLX-6250 Series installation window, you can see Wireless  
Setting and Installation menu. You can use this menu if an  
optional wireless network card is installed and/or the machine  
is connected to your computer with a USB cable.  
the printer to the network or locally.  
-Check this option to install this program without a machine  
connected. In this case, the print a test page window will be  
skipped, and completes the installation.  
Install the optional wireless network card. Instructions for  
Wireless Setting and Installation, refer to the wireless  
network installation guide provided with the optional wireless  
network card.  
Search again  
When you press this button, the firewall notice window  
appears;  
-Turn off the firewall and Search again. For Window operating  
system, click Start > Control Panel > Windows Firewall,  
and inactivate this option. For other operating systems,  
refer to their on-line guides.  
-Turn off all firewall from the third party's program beside the  
operating system. Refer to the manual provided by  
individual programs.  
The Advanced Installation has two options, Custom  
Installation and Install Software Only. Custom Installation  
allows you to select the machine’s connection and choose  
individual component to install. Install Software Only allows  
you to install the supplied software, such as Smart Panel.  
Follow the guide in the window.  
Administrator Installation provides convenient installation  
methods useful for administrators (See "Administrator’s Guide  
Direct Input  
The Direct Input allows you to search a specific machine on  
the network.  
-Search by IP address: Enter the IP address or the host  
4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the  
License Agreement. Then, click Next.  
name. Then click Next.  
To verify your machine’s IP address, print a network  
configuration report (See "Printing a machine report" on  
page 1).  
-Search by network path: To find a shared machine (UNC  
Path), enter the shared name manually or find a shared  
printer by clicking the Browse button. Then click Next.  
Help  
If your machine is not connected to the computer or network,  
This help button gives detailed information about the how to  
connect the machine.  
5. The searched machines will be shown on the screen. Select the one you  
wish to use and click Next.  
If the driver searched only one machine, the confirmation window  
appears.  
6. After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page  
appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page.  
Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 8.  
7. If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes.  
If not, click No to reprint it.  
The program searches for the machine.  
If your machine is not found in the network or locally, the following  
8. To register as a user of the machine in order to receive information from  
Samsung, click On-line Registration.  
Network setup_ 4  
9. Click Finish.  
After the driver setup, you may enable firewall.  
For Mac OS X 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Samsung in Print Using and your machine name in Model.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Select a driver to use... and your machine name in Print Using.  
Your machine appears on the Printer List, and is set as the default  
machine.  
If the printer driver does not work properly, follow the steps below to  
repair or reinstall the driver.  
a)Make sure that the machine is connected to your machine and  
powered on.  
b)From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs >  
Samsung Printers > your printer driver name >  
Maintenance.  
21. Click Add.  
If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and  
reinstall it.  
Follow steps below to uninstall the driver for Macintosh.  
c)Select the option as you wish, follow the instruction on the  
window.  
a)Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
Macintosh  
b)Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and powered  
c)Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh  
desktop.  
on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
3. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop.  
4. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder.  
d)Double-click the MAC_Installer folder.  
e)Double-click the Installer OS X icon.  
f)Enter the password and click OK.  
5. Double-click the Installer OS X icon.  
6. Enter the password and click OK.  
g)The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue.  
h)Select Uninstall and click Uninstall.  
7. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue.  
8. Read the license agreement and click Continue.  
9. Click Agree to agree to the license agreement.  
10. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue.  
11. Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for  
most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be  
installed.  
i)When the message which warns that all applications will close on  
your computer appears, Click Continue.  
j)When the uninstall is done, click Quit.  
Linux  
Install Linux Driver  
1.Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and  
powered on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set.  
2.From the Samsung website, download the Unified Linux Driver  
package to your computer.  
3.Right click the Unified Linux Driver package and extract the package.  
4.Double click cdroot > autorun.  
5.The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue.  
6.The Add printer wizard window opens. Click Next.  
7.Select Network printer and click Search button.  
8.The Printer’s IP address and model name appears on list field.  
9.Select your machine and click Next.  
If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual components to  
install.  
12. The message which warns that all applications will close on your  
computer appears. Click Continue.  
If you select Typical installation for a network printer during the  
machine driver installation, the SetIP program automatically runs.  
If the machine has already configured network information, close  
the SetIP program. Go to the next step.  
13. After the installation is finished, click Quit.  
14. Open the Applications folder > Utilities > Print Setup Utility.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, open the Applications folder > System  
Preferences and click Print & Fax.  
15. Click Add on the Printer List.  
10.Input the printer description and Next.  
11.When the add printer is done, click Finish.  
12.When the install is done, click Finish.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click the “+” icon; a display window will pop  
up.  
Add network Printer  
1.Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator.  
2.Click Add Printer…  
3.The Add printer wizard window opens. Click Next.  
4.Select Network printer and click the Search button.  
5.The printer’s IP address and model name appears on list field.  
6.Select your machine and click Next.  
7.Input the printer description and Next  
8.When the add printer is done, click Finish.  
16. For Mac OS X 10.3, select the IP Printing tab.  
For Mac OS X 10.4, click IP Printer.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click IP.  
17. Select Socket/HP Jet Direct in Printer Type.  
When printing a document containing many pages, printing  
performance may be enhanced by choosing Socket for Printer  
Type option.  
18. Enter the machine’s IP address in the Printer Address field.  
19. Enter the queue name in the Queue Name field. If you cannot determine  
the queue name for your machine server, try using the default queue  
first.  
UNIX  
To use UNIX Printer Driver, you have to install the UNIX printer driver  
package first, then setup the printer. You can download the UNIX Printer  
Driver package from the Samsung website.  
20. For Mac OS X 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Samsung in Printer Model and your machine name in Model Name.  
Network setup_ 5  
 
4.Specify any printer description in the Description field. This is  
Installing the UNIX printer driver package  
Installation procedure is common for all variants of UNIX OS mentioned  
optional.  
5.Specify printer location in the Location field.  
6.Type the IP address or DNS name of the printer in the Device textbox  
for network-connected printers. On IBM AIX with jetdirect Queue  
type only DNS name is possible, numeric IP address is not allowed.  
7.Queue type shows the connection as lpd or jetdirect in the  
corresponding list box. Additionally usb type is available on Sun  
Solaris OS.  
1.From the Samsung website, download and unpack the UNIX Printer  
Driver package to your computer.  
2.Acquire root privileges.  
su -  
3.Copy appropriate driver archive to the target UNIX computer.  
8.Select Copies to set the number of copies.  
See administration guide of your UNIX OS for details.  
9.Check the Collate option to receive copies already sorted.  
10.Check the Reverse Order option to receive copies in the reverse  
4.Unpack the UNIX printer driver package archive.  
For example, on IBM AIX use the following commands.  
cd /tmp  
order.  
11.Check the Make Default option to set this printer as default.  
12.Click OK to add the printer.  
gzip –dc /cdrom/unix/packages/aix_power/aix_power.tar.gz | tar  
–xvf –  
The “binaries” folder consists of binz, install, share files and folders  
5.Copy the “binaries” folder to any local folder.  
6.Change to the driver’s “binaries” directory.  
cd aix_power/binaries  
IPv6 Configuration  
TCP/IPv6 is supported properly only in Windows Vista or higher.  
If the IPv6 network seems to not be working, set all the network setting  
to the factory defaults and try again (See "Restoring factory default  
7.Run the install script.  
./install  
install is the installer script file which is used to install or uninstall the  
UNIX Printer Driver package.  
Use “chmod 755 install” command to give the permission to the  
To use the IPv6 network environment, follow the next procedure to use the  
IPv6 address:  
installer script.  
1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable.  
8.Execute the “. /install –c” command to verify install results.  
2. Turn on the machine.  
9.Run ‘installprinter’ from the command line. This will bring up the Add  
Printer Wizard window. Setup the printer in this window referring the  
procedure next.  
3. Print a Network Configuration Report from the machine’s control  
panel that will check IPv6 addresses.  
a)Press Menu on the control panel.  
b)Press the up/down arrow to highlight Network and press OK.  
c)Press the up/down arrow to highlight Network Info. and press  
On some UNIX OS, for example on Solaris 10 just added  
printer may not be enabled and/or may not accept jobs. In this  
case run the following two commands on the root terminal:  
accept <printer_name>  
enable <printer_name>  
OK.  
4. Select Start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers > Add  
Printer.  
5. Click Add a local printer on the Add Printer windows.  
6. Follow the instruction on the window.  
Uninstalling the printer driver package  
The uninstalling printer utility should be used to delete the printer  
installed in the system.  
If the machine does not work in the network environment, activate  
IPv6. Refer to the next section followed by.  
a)Run “uninstallprinter” command from the terminal.  
It will open the Uninstall Printer Wizard  
The installed printers are listed in the drop-down list  
b)Select the printer to be deleted.  
c)Click Delete to delete the printer from the system.  
d)Execute the “. /install –d” command to uninstall the whole  
Activating IPv6  
1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable.  
2. Turned on the machine.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
4. Press up/down arrow to highlight Network and press OK.  
5. Press up/down arrow to highlight TCP/IP (IPv6) and press OK.  
6. Press up/down arrow to highlight IPv6 Activate and press OK.  
7. Press up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
package.  
e)To verify uninstall results, execute the “. /install –c” command.  
To reinstall it again, use the command “. /install” to reinstall the binaries.  
Setting up the printer  
To add the printer to your UNIX system, run ‘installprinter’ from the  
command line. This will bring up the Add Printer Wizard window. Setup  
the printer in this window according to the following steps:  
On is set as a default.  
8. Turn the machine off and turn it on again.  
9. Print a Network Configuration Report from the machine’s control  
panel that will check IPv6 addresses.  
1.Type the name of the printer.  
2.Select appropriate printer model from model list.  
3.Enter any decsription corresponding to the type of the printer in the  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press up/down arrow to highlight Network and press OK.  
3.Press up/down arrow to highlight Network Info. and press OK.  
Type field. This is optional.  
Network setup_ 6  
 
Setting IPv6 addresses  
Machine supports following IPv6 addresses for network printing and  
managements.  
Connecting SyncThru™ Web Service  
1. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer that supports IPv6  
addressing as a URL .  
Link-local Address: Self-configured local IPv6 address. (Address starts  
with FE80.)  
Stateless Address: Automatically configured IPv6 address by a  
network router.  
Stateful Address: IPv6 address configured by a DHCPv6 server.  
Manual Address: Manually configured IPv6 address by a user.  
2. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
3. Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.  
A log-in page appears.  
4. Type in the ID and Password then click Login .  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
Password: sec00000  
5. Select one of the IPv6 addresses (Link-local Address, Stateless  
Address, Stateful Address, Manual Address) from Network  
Configuration Report.  
DHCPv6 address configuration (Stateful)  
If you have a DHCPv6 server on your network, you can set one of the  
following option for default dynamic host configuration:  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press up/down arrow to highlight Network and press OK.  
3.Press up/down arrow to highlight TCP/IP (IPv6) and press OK.  
4.Press up/down arrow to highlight DHCPv6 Config and press OK.  
5.Press up/down arrow to access the required value.  
Routers: Use DHCPv6 only when requested by a router.  
6. Enter the IPv6 addresses. (ex: http://[FE80::215:99FF:FE66:7701])  
Address must be enclosed in '[]' brackets.  
DHCPv6 Addresses: Always use DHCPv6 regardless of router  
request.  
DHCPv6 Off: Never use DHCPv6 regardless of router request.  
6.Press OK.  
Manual address configuration  
1.Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer that supports IPv6  
For IPv4, enter the IPv4 address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the  
address field and press the Enter key or click Go.  
2.Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service  
website.  
A log-in page appears.  
3.Type in the ID and Password then click Login .  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
Password: sec00000  
4.When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Settings >  
Network Settings.  
5.Click TCP/IPv6.  
6.Enable the Manual Address In the TCP/IPv6 section.  
IPv6 Protocol should enable.  
7.Select the Address / Prefix and click the Add button, then the router  
prefix will automatically be entered into the address field.  
Enter the rest of address. (ex: 3FFE:10:88:194::AAAA. “A” is the  
hexadecimal 0 through 9, A through F.)  
8.Click the Apply button.  
Installing printer driver  
Driver installation for network printer in IPv6 network environment is same  
page 3).  
Select TCP/IP Port and when the list of machines are displayed, simply  
select your machine's IPv6 address.  
Network setup_ 7  
 
1.  
basic setup  
After installation is complete, you may want to set the machine’s default settings. Refer to the next section if you would like  
to set or change values. This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the machine.  
This chapter includes:  
System > Setup > Altitude Ad.. Select the appropriate altitude value,  
and then click Apply.  
Altitude adjustment  
The print quality is affected by atmospheric pressure, which is determined  
by the height of the machine above sea level. The following information will  
guide you on how to set your machine to the best print quality or best quality  
of print.  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
Password: sec00000  
Before you set the altitude value, determine the altitude where you are.  
Changing the display language  
To change the language that appears on the display, follow the steps below:  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
1 High 3  
2 High 2  
3 High 1  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Language and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to display the language you want.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
4 Normal  
0
In the control panel  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Altitude Adjust and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the setting option you want appears.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
Setting the date and time  
When you set the time and date, they are used in delay fax and delay print.  
They are printed on reports. If, however, they are not correct, you need to  
correct it to the present date and time.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
If the machine’s power is cut off, you need to reset the correct time  
and date once the power has been restored.  
In the computer  
1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or  
Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status  
bar in Mac OS X (See "Understanding Smart Panel" on page 2).  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Date & Time and press OK.  
Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu,  
select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer  
driver name > Smart Panel.  
5. Enter the correct time and date using up/down, left/right arrow or  
numeric keypad.  
Month = 01 to 12,  
Day = 01 to 31,  
2. Click Printer Setting.  
3. Click Setting > Altitude Adjustment. Select the appropriate value from  
the dropdown list, and then click Apply.  
Year = requires four digits,  
Hour = 01 to 12,  
If your machine is connected to a network, SyncThru™ Web Service  
screen appears automatically. Click Settings > Machine Settings >  
Minute = 00 to 59  
Basic setup_ 1  
         
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
1. Press On Hook Dial. A dial tone sounds from the earpiece.  
2. Press the left/right arrow until you hear the volume you want.  
3. Press On Hook Dial to save the change and return to ready mode.  
Changing the clock mode  
Entering characters using the number keypad  
You can set your machine to display the current time using either a 12-hour  
or 24-hour format.  
As you perform various tasks, you may need to enter names and numbers.  
For example, when you set up your machine, you enter your name or your  
company’s name, and the fax number. When you store fax numbers or  
email addresses in memory, you may also enter the corresponding names.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Clock Mode and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to select the other mode and press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Entering alphanumeric characters  
1. When you are prompted to enter a letter, locate the button labeled with  
the character you want. Press the button until the correct letter appears  
on the display.  
For example, to enter the letter O, press 6, labeled with MNO.  
Each time you press 6, the display shows a different letter, M, N, O, m,  
n, o and finally 6.  
You can enter special characters, such as space, plus sign, and etc. For  
details, see the below section.  
Changing the default mode  
Your machine is preset to Copy mode. You can switch this default mode  
between Fax mode and Copy mode.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. To enter additional letters, repeat step 1.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Default Mode and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to select the mode you want.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
If the next letter is printed on the same button, move the cursor by  
pressing the left/right arrow button and then press the button labeled  
with the letter you want. The cursor will move to the right and the next  
letter will appear on the display.  
You can enter a space by pressing 1 twice.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
3. When you have finished entering letters, press OK.  
Keypad letters and numbers  
Setting sounds  
Some of the follow key values may not appear depending on the job  
you are doing.  
You can control the following sounds:  
Key Sound: Turns the key sound On or Off. With this option set to On,  
a tone sounds each time a key is pressed.  
Key  
Assigned numbers, letters, or characters  
Alarm Sound: Turns the alarm sound On or Off. With this option set to  
On, an alarm tone sounds when an error occurs or fax communication  
ends.  
Speaker: Turns On or Off the sounds from the telephone line through  
the speaker, such as a dial tone or a fax tone. With this option set to  
Comm. which means “Comm.”, the speaker is on until the remote  
machine answers.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
*
@ / . ‘ 1  
A B C a b c 2  
D E F d e f 3  
G H I g h i 4  
You can adjust the volume level using On Hook Dial.  
J K L j k l 5  
Ringer: Adjusts the ringer volume. For the ringer volume, you can  
select Off, Low, Mid, and High.  
M N O m n o 6  
P Q R S p q r s 7  
T U V t u v 8  
W X Y Z w x y z 9  
& + - , 0_  
Speaker, ringer, key sound, and alarm sound  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Sound/Volume and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the sound option you want highlights and  
*
press OK.  
% ^ ~ ! # $ ( ) [ ] (These symbols are available when you type  
for network authentication.)  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the desired status or volume for the sound  
you have selected highlights and press OK.  
6. If necessary, repeat steps 4 through 5 to set other sounds.  
#
#
= | ? " : { } < > ; (These symbols are available when you type for  
network authentication.)  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Speaker volume  
To adjust the volume using On Hook Dial:  
Basic setup_ 2  
           
Correcting numbers or names  
If you make a mistake while entering a number or name, press the left/right  
arrow button to delete the last digit or character. Then enter the correct  
number or character.  
Paper substitution  
This option is to prevent the paper mismatch between tray and the printer  
driver. For example, if you have A4 paper in the tray but you set the paper  
size to Letter in the printer driver, the machine prints on A4 paper and vice  
versa.  
Inserting a pause  
This option only works for mismatch between A4 and Letter paper.  
With some telephone systems, you must dial an access code (9, for  
example) and listen for a second dial tone. In such cases, you must insert a  
pause in the telephone number. You can insert a pause while you are  
setting up speed dial numbers.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Substitution and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
To insert a pause, press Redial/Pause at the appropriate place while  
entering the telephone number. A dash(-) appears on the display at the  
corresponding location.  
Using the power saving mode  
Net accounting  
When you are not using the machine for a while, use this feature to save  
power.  
This is the option limits the number of use for fax, printer, copy and scan.  
First, the administrator needs to install the Job account Plug-in from  
SyncThru™ Web Admin Service. Then, create user accounts by entering  
user ID and Password in SyncThru™ Web Admin Service.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Power Save and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to select the time you want.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
If you are not registered, request Administrator for a registration.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Net Accounting and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the setting option you want appears.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Setting job timeout  
Protect: Select the option for which you want to enable or disable net  
accounting.  
When there is no input for a certain period of time, the machine exits the  
current menu and goes in to the default settings. You can set the amount of  
time the machine will wait.  
Change Password: The access password code can be changed.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Job Timeout and press OK.  
5. Enter the time using up/down arrow or numeric keypad.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
Setting the color report  
This menu allows you to print reports in color.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Color Report and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Auto continue  
This is the option to set the machine to continue printing or not, in case that  
the paper size you have set and the paper in the tray mismatches.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Setting the default tray and paper  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Auto Continue and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the setting option you want appears.  
You can select the tray and paper you would like to keep using for printing  
job.  
Wide A4 is useful when printing in DOS mode. This option prints 80  
charactors in a line, which printing 78 charactors in a line is usual in  
DOS mode.  
On: Automatically prints after set time passes, when the paper size  
mismatches the tray paper size.  
Off: Waits until you press Start on the control panel, when the paper  
size mismatches the tray paper size.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
In the control panel  
Setting the paper size  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Setup and press OK.  
Basic setup_ 3  
               
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Size and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to select the paper tray you want and press  
1.Open a Macintosh application and select the file you want to print.  
2.Open the File menu and click Print.  
3.Go to Paper Feed pane.  
OK.  
6.Press the up/down arrow to select the paper size you want.  
7.Press OK to save the selection.  
4.Set appropriate tray from which you want to print.  
5.Go to Paper pane.  
8.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
6.Set paper type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray from  
which you want to print.  
7.Click Print to print.  
Setting the paper type  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
Linux  
1.Open Terminal Program  
2.When the Terminal screen appears, type in the following:  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Setup and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Type and press OK.  
[root@localhost root]# lpr [FileName]  
5.Press the up/down arrow to select the paper tray you want and press  
OK.  
3.Select Printer and click Properties…  
4.Click Advanced tab.  
5.Select tray (source) and its options, such as paper size and type.  
6.Press OK.  
6.Press the up/down arrow to select the paper type you want.  
7.Press OK to save the selection.  
8.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Setting the paper source  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
Changing the font setting  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Setup and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Source and press OK.  
Your machine has preset the font for your region or country.  
If you want to change the font or set the font for special condition, such as  
the DOS environment, you can change the font setting as follows:  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Tray or Fax Tray and  
1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or  
Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status  
bar in Mac OS X.  
press OK.  
6.Press the up/down arrow to select the paper tray you want.  
7.Press OK to save the selection.  
8.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu,  
select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer  
driver name > Smart Panel.  
In the computer  
2. Click Printer Setting.  
3. Click Emulation.  
4. Confirm if PCL is selected in Emulation Setting.  
5. Click Apply.  
Windows  
1.Click the Windows Start menu.  
2.For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
Following information shows the proper font list for corresponding  
languages.  
Russian: CP866, ISO 8859/5 Latin Cyrillic  
Hebrew: Hebrew 15Q, Hebrew-8, Hebrew-7 (Israel only)  
Greek: ISO 8859/7 Latin Greek, PC-8 Latin/Greek  
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and  
Sound > Printers.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Devices and Printers.  
Arabic & Farsi: HP Arabic-8, Windows Arabic, Code Page 864,  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Farsi, ISO 8859/6 Latin Arabic  
Devices and Printers.  
OCR: OCR-A, OCR-B  
3.Right-click your machine.  
4.For Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, press Printing Preferences.  
For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus,  
select the Printing Preferences.  
If Printing Preferences item has mark, you can select other  
printer drivers connected with selected printer.  
5.Click Paper tab.  
6.Select tray and its options, such as paper size and type.  
7.Press OK.  
If you want to use special-sized paper such as a billing paper,  
select Paper tab > Size > Edit... in the Printing Preferences (See  
Macintosh  
Macintosh does not support this function. Macintosh users need to  
change the default setting manually each time they want to print using  
other settings.  
Basic setup_ 4  
 
1.  
media and tray  
This chapter provides information on how to load originals and print media into your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
1. Lift and open the scanner lid.  
Preparing originals  
Do not load paper smaller than 142 x 148 mm (5.6 x 5.8 inches) or  
larger than 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches).  
Do not attempt to load the following types of paper, in order to prevent  
paper jam, low print quality and machine damage.  
-Carbon-paper or carbon-backed paper  
-Coated paper  
-Onion skin or thin paper  
-Wrinkled or creased paper  
-Curled or rolled paper  
-Torn paper  
-Used paper (Something previously printed on side one)  
Remove all staples and paper clips before loading.  
Make sure any glue, ink, or correction fluid on the paper is completely  
dry before loading.  
2. Place the original face down on the scanner glass. And align it with the  
Do not load originals that include different sizes or weights of paper.  
Do not load booklets, pamphlets, transparencies, or documents with  
other unusual characteristics.  
registration guide at the top left corner of the glass.  
Loading originals  
You can use the scanner glass or the automatic document feeder to load an  
original for copying, scanning and sending a fax.  
On the scanner glass  
Make sure that no originals are in the document feeder. If an original is  
detected in the document feeder, the machine gives it priority over the  
original on the scanner glass. To get the best scan quality, especially for  
colored or gray-scaled images, use the scanner glass.  
3. Close the scanner lid.  
Leaving the scanner lid open while copying will create a black  
copy, and consume a great deal of toner.  
Dust on the scanner glass may cause black spots on the printout.  
Always keep it clean (See "Cleaning the scan unit" on page 3).  
If you are copying a page from a book or magazine, lift the  
scanner lid until its hinges are caught by the stopper and then  
close the lid. If the book or magazine is thicker than 30 mm,  
start copying with the lid open.  
Media and tray_ 1  
       
Be careful not to break the scanner glass. You may get hurt.  
Do not put hands while closing the scanner lid. The scanner lid  
may fall on your hands and get hurt.  
Do not look the light from inside of the scanner while copying or  
scanning. It is harmful to eyes.  
Selecting print media  
You can print on a variety of print media, such as plain paper, envelopes,  
labels. Always use print media that meet the guidelines for use with your  
machine.  
Guidelines to select the print media  
In the document feeder  
Print media that does not meet the guidelines outlined in this user’s guide  
may cause the following problems:  
Using the document feeder, you can load up to 40 sheets of paper (80 g/m2,  
20 lb bond) for one job.  
Poor print quality  
Increased paper jams  
Premature wear on the machine.  
1. Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before  
loading originals.  
Properties, such as weight, composition, grain and moisture content, are  
important factors that affect the machine’s performance and the output  
quality. When you choose print materials, consider the following:  
The type, size and weight of the print media for your machine are  
described in print media specifications (See "Print media specifications"  
Desired outcome: The print media you choose should be appropriate for  
your project.  
Brightness: Some print media are whiter than others and produce  
sharper, more vibrant images.  
Surface smoothness: The smoothness of the print media affects how  
crisp the printing looks on the paper.  
2. Load the original face up into the document feeder. Make sure that the  
bottom of the original stack matches the paper size marked on the  
document input tray.  
Some print media may meet all of the guidelines in this section and  
still not produce satisfactory results. This may be the result of  
improper handling, unacceptable temperature and humidity levels,  
or other variables over which cannot be controlled.  
Before purchasing large quantities of print media, ensure that it  
meets the requirements specifications in this user’s guide and  
meets your output requirements.  
Using print media that does not meet these specifications may cause  
problems, requiring repairs. Such repairs are not covered by the  
warranty or service agreements.  
3. Adjust the document width guides to the paper size.  
The amount of paper put into the tray may differ according to media type  
Media sizes supported in each mode  
Mode  
Size  
Source  
Tray 1  
Optional tray 2  
Multi-purpose tray  
Copy mode  
Letter, A4, Legal,  
Oficio, Folio,  
Executive, ISO B5, JIS  
B5, A5, A6  
Print mode  
All sizes supported by  
the machine.  
Tray 1  
Optional tray 2  
Multi-purpose tray  
Fax mode  
Letter, A4, Legal  
Tray 1  
Optional tray 2  
Dust on the document feeder glass may cause black lines on the  
printout. Always keep the glass clean (See "Cleaning the scan  
Duplex printinga  
Letter, A4, Legal, Folio,  
Oficio  
Tray 1  
Optional tray 2  
Multi-purpose tray  
a.75 to 105 g/m2 (20~28 lb bond) only  
Media and tray_ 2  
 
jams.  
Changing the tray size  
The tray is preset to Letter or A4 size, depending on your country. To  
change the size, you need to adjust the paper guides.  
Loading paper in the tray  
Tray 1/optional tray 2  
Load the print media you use for the majority of your print jobs into tray 1.  
Tray 1 can hold a maximum of 250 sheets of plain paper.  
You can purchase an optional tray and attach it below the standard tray to  
load an additional 500 sheets of plain paper (See "Available accessories"  
1 Tray extend lever  
2 Paper length guide  
3 Paper width guide  
1. Hold the tray with one hand, and with the other hand squeeze and slide  
the paper length guide to locate them in the correct paper size slot  
marked at the bottom of the tray.  
Using photographic paper or coated paper may cause problems,  
requiring repairs. Such repairs are not covered by the warranty or  
service agreements.  
1. Pull out tray. And adjust the tray size to the media size you are loading  
2. Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before  
loading papers.  
2. Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before  
loading papers.  
3. Place paper with the side you want to print facing up.  
3. After inserting paper into the tray, squeeze the paper width guides and  
paper length guide. Then slide them to the desired paper size marked at  
the bottom of the tray.  
1 Paper limit mark  
2 Paper level  
indicator  
1 Paper length guide  
2 Paper width guide  
Do not push the paper width guide too far causing the media to  
warp.  
If you do not adjust the paper width guide, it may cause paper  
Media and tray_ 3  
     
Paper quantity indicator shows the amount of paper in the tray.  
1.Grab the handle of multi-purpose tray and pull it down to open.  
2.Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before  
loading papers.  
1 Full  
2 Empty  
4. When you print a document, set the paper type and size for the tray.  
For information about setting the paper type and size on the control  
3.Load the paper with the side to be printed on facing down.  
If you experience problems with paper feeding, check whether the  
paper meets the media specification. Then, try placing one  
sheet at a time in the multi-purpose tray (See "Print media  
The settings made from the machine driver override the settings  
on the control panel.  
a)To print in application, open an application and start the print  
menu.  
b)Open Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing  
c)Press the Paper tab in Printing Preferences, and select an  
appropriate paper type.  
d)Select tray in paper source, then press OK.  
e)Start printing in application.  
4.Squeeze the multi-purpose tray paper width guides and adjust them to  
the width of the paper. Do not force too much, or the paper will bent  
resulting in a paper jam or skew.  
Multi-purpose tray  
The multi-purpose tray can hold special sizes and types of print material,  
such as postcards, note cards and envelopes. It is useful for single page  
printing on colored paper.  
Tips on using the multi-purpose tray  
Load only one type, size and weight of print media at a time in the  
multi-purpose tray.  
To prevent paper jams, do not add paper while printing when there is  
still paper in the multi-purpose tray. This also applies to other types  
of print media.  
Always load the specified print media only to avoid paper jams and print  
quality problems (See "Print media specifications" on page 3).  
Flatten any curl on postcards, envelopes and labels before loading  
them into the multi-purpose tray.  
When printing the special media, you must follow the loading  
When paper does not feed well while printing, push the paper  
in manually until it starts feeding automatically.  
Media and tray_ 4  
5.When you print a document, set the paper type and size for the  
Thick: 90 to 105 g/m2 (24 to 28 lb) thick paper.  
Thicker: 106 to 120 g/m2 (28 to 32 lb) thicker paper.  
Extra Thick: 120 to 170 g/m2 (32 to 46 lb) extra thick.  
Thin: 60 to 70 g/m2 (16 to 19 lb) thin paper.  
multi-purpose tray.  
For information about setting the paper type and size on the control  
Cotton: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb) cotton paper.  
Color: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb) color-backgrounded paper.  
Preprinted: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb) preprinted/letterhead paper.  
Recycled: 70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lb) recycled paper.  
The settings made from the machine driver override the  
settings on the control panel.  
a)To print in application, open an application and start the print  
menu.  
b)Open Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing  
c)Press the Paper tab in Printing Preferences, and select an  
When you use recycled paper as a used paper, printouts might be  
wrinkled and/or jamming may occur due to excessive curl.  
Envelope: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb) envelope.  
Labels: 120 to 150 g/m2 (32 to 40 lb) label.  
CardStock: 171 to 220 g/m2 (46 to 59 lb) cardstock.  
Bond: 105 to 120 g/m2 (28 to 32 lb) bond.  
appropriate paper type.  
For example, if you want to use a label, set the paper type  
to Label.  
d)Select Manual Feeder in paper source, then press OK.  
e)Start printing in application.  
f)After printing, close the multi-purpose tray.  
Archive: 70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lb). If you need to keep the print-out for  
a long period time, such as archives, select this option.  
Glossy Photo: 111 to 130 g/m2 (30 to 35lb), 131 to 175 g/m2 (35 to  
47lb), 176 to 220 g/m2 (47 to 59lb) glossy photo paper.  
Printing on special media  
Matte Photo: 111 to 130 g/m2 (30 to 35lb), 131 to 175 g/m2 (35 to 47lb),  
176 to 220 g/m2 (47 to 59lb) matte photo paper.  
The table below shows the available special media for each tray.  
When using special media, we recommend you feed one paper at a  
time. Check the maximum input number of media for each tray (See  
Envelope  
Successful printing on envelopes depends upon the quality of the  
envelopes.  
To print an envelope, place it flap side up with the stamp area bottm the top  
right side.  
Multi-purpose  
Types  
Plain  
Tray 1  
Optional tray  
tray  
Thick  
Thicker  
Extra Thick  
Thin  
Cotton  
Color  
Preprinted  
Recycled  
Envelope  
Labels  
When selecting envelopes, consider the following factors:  
-Weight: The weight of the envelope paper should not exceed 90 g/m2  
otherwise, jam may occur.  
-Construction: Prior to printing, envelopes should lie flat with less than  
6 mm curl, and should not contain air.  
-Condition: Envelopes should not be wrinkled, nicked, either damaged.  
CardStock  
Bond  
-Temperature: Use envelopes that are compatible with the heat and  
pressure of the machine during operation.  
Use only well-constructed envelopes with sharp-and well-creased folds.  
Do not use stamped envelopes.  
Do not use envelopes with clasps, snaps, windows, coated lining,  
self-adhesive seals, or other synthetic materials.  
Archive  
Glossy Photo  
Matte Photo  
Do not use damaged or poorly made envelopes.  
Be sure the seam at both ends of the envelope extends all the way to  
the corner of the envelope.  
( : Supported, Blank: Not supported)  
The media types are shown in the Printing Preferences. This paper type  
option allows you to set the type of paper to be loaded in the tray. This  
setting appears in the list, so that you can select it. This will let you get the  
best quality printout. If not, the desired print quality may not be achieved.  
Plain: 70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lb) Normal plain paper.  
Media and tray_ 5  
 
Do not print on media smaller than 98 mm (3.9 inches) wide or 148 mm  
(5.8 inches) long.  
In the software application, set margins at least 6.4 mm (0.25 inches)  
away from the edges of the material.  
1
2
Acceptable  
Unacceptable  
Envelopes with a peel-off adhesive strip or with more than one flap that  
folds over to seal must use adhesives compatible with the machine’s  
fusing temperature about 170°C (338 °F) for 0.1 second. The extra flaps  
and strips might cause wrinkling, creasing, or jams and may even  
damage the fuser.  
For the best print quality, position margins no closer than 15 mm from  
the edges of the envelope.  
Letterhead/Preprinted paper  
Single-sided  
double-sided  
Face down  
Tray1  
Optional tray  
Face up  
Avoid printing over the area where the envelope’s seams meet.  
Labels  
To avoid damaging the machine, use only labels designed for use in laser  
machines.  
Multi-purpose Face down  
Face up  
tray  
When selecting labels, consider the following factors:  
-Adhesives: The adhesive material should be stable at your machine’s  
Letterhead/ Preprinted paper must be printed with heat-resistant ink that  
will not melt, vaporize, or release hazardous emissions when subjected  
to the machine’s fusing temperature for 0.1 second. Check your  
machine’s specification to view the fusing temperature about 170°C (338  
°F).  
fusing temperature about 170°C (338 °F).  
-Arrangement: Only use labels with no exposed backing between  
them. Labels can peel off sheets that have spaces between the  
labels, causing serious jams.  
-Curl: Prior to printing, labels must lie flat with no more than 13 mm of  
curl in any direction.  
-Condition: Do not use labels with wrinkles, bubbles, or other  
Letterhead/ Preprinted paper ink must be non-flammable and should not  
adversely affect machine rollers.  
Forms and letterhead should be sealed in a moisture-proof wrapping to  
prevent changes during storage.  
Before you load letterhead/preprinted paper, verify that the ink on the  
paper is dry. During the fusing process, wet ink can come off preprinted  
paper, reducing print quality.  
indications of separation.  
Make sure that there is no exposed adhesive material between labels.  
Exposed areas can cause labels to peel off during printing, which can  
cause paper jams. Exposed adhesive can also cause damage to  
machine components.  
Do not run a sheet of labels through the machine more than once. The  
adhesive backing is designed for only a single pass through the  
machine.  
Do not use labels that are separating from the backing sheet or are  
wrinkled, bubbled, or otherwise damaged.  
Used paper  
When loading used paper, printed side should be facing up with an uncurled  
edge at the front. If you experience problems with paper feed, turn the paper  
around. Note that print quality is not guaranteed.  
Card stock/Custom-sized paper  
Used paper must be printed with heat-resistant ink that will not melt,  
vaporize, or release hazardous emissions when subjected to the  
Media and tray_ 6  
machine’s fusing temperature for 0.1 second. Check your machine’s  
specification to view the fusing temperature about 170°C(338 °F).  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Used paper ink must be non-flammable and should not adversely affect  
machine rollers.  
Before you load used paper, verify that the ink on the paper is dry.  
During the fusing process, wet ink can come off used paper, reducing  
print quality.  
Setting the paper source  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Source and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Tray or Fax Tray and press  
Photo  
OK.  
Make sure not to use the inkjet photo paper with this machine. It could  
cause damage to the machine.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to select the paper tray you want.  
7. Press OK to save the selection.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Glossy photo  
If you want to use special-sized paper-such as a billing paper, select  
Edit.. in the Paper tab in the Printing Preferences (See "Opening  
Load one paper to the multi-purpose tray at a time, glossy side facing  
down.  
Recommended media: Glossy paper (Letter) for this machine by HP  
Brochure Paper (Product: Q6611A) only.  
Recommended media: Glossy paper (A4) for this machine by HP  
Superior Paper 160 glossy (Product: Q6616A).  
Selecting an output location  
The surface of the output tray may become hot if you print a large  
number of pages at once. Make sure that you do not touch the  
surface, and do not allow children near it.  
Matte photo  
Load one paper to the multi-purpose tray at a time, side to be printed  
facing down.  
The printed pages stack on the output tray, and the output support will help  
the printed pages to align. For the output support to correctly align the  
pages, you need to pull it out appropriately depending on the paper size.  
Setting the paper size and type  
After loading paper in the paper tray, set the paper size and type using the  
control panel. These settings will apply to copy and fax modes. For  
computer printing, select the paper size and type in the application program  
you use on your computer (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2).  
The settings made from the machine driver override the settings on  
the control panel.  
Setting the paper size  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Size and press OK.  
1 Output support  
2 Extension  
If paper coming out of the output try has problems, such as excessive  
curl, try printing to the rear door.  
If the output support is incorrectly adjusted, printed pages may be  
mis-aligned or fall.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to select the paper tray you want and press  
OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to select the paper size you want.  
7. Press OK to save the selection.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
If you want to use special-sized paper-such as a billing paper, select  
Custom in the Paper tab in the Printing Preferences (See "Opening  
Setting the paper type  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Paper Type and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to select the paper tray you want and press  
OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to select the paper type you want.  
7. Press OK to save the selection.  
Media and tray_ 7  
     
For Letter-sized paper  
Pull out the output support to the location indicated LTR as shown, and  
unfold the extension.  
For A4- or Legal-sized paper  
Pull out the output support to the location indicated A4, LGL as shown, and  
unfold the extension.  
Media and tray_ 8  
1.  
printing  
This chapter explains common printing tasks.  
This chapter includes:  
The procedures in this chapter are mainly based on Windows XP.  
PCL Printer driver  
Feature  
Windows  
Introducing useful software programs  
Samsung AnyWeb Print  
This tool helps you to screen-capture, preview, scrap and print the screen of  
Windows Internet Explorer more easily, than when you use the ordinary  
program. Click Start > All programs > Samsung Printers > Samsung  
AnyWeb Print > Download the lastest version to link the website where  
the tool is available for the download. This tool is available only for Windows  
operating systems.  
Machine quality option  
Booklet printing  
Poster printing  
Multiple pages per sheet  
Fit to page printing  
Reduce and enlarge printing  
Different source for first page  
Watermark  
Samsung Easy Color Manager  
This program helps users to adjust color as they like. Users can adjust the  
printout color as they see them on the monitor. The adjusted color can be  
from http://solution.samsungprinter.com/personal/colormanager.  
Overlay  
Double-sided printing (duplex)  
( : Supported, Blank: Not supported)  
PostScript Printer driver  
Printer driver features  
Feature  
Windows  
Linux  
Macintosh  
Your printer drivers support the following standard features:  
Machine quality option  
Poster printing  
Paper orientation, size, source and media type selection  
Number of copies  
In addition, you can use various special printing features. The following  
table shows a general overview of features supported by your printer  
drivers:  
Multiple pages per sheet  
(2, 4)  
Fit to page printing  
Some models or operating system may not support the certain  
feature(s) in the following table.  
Reduce and enlarge  
printing  
Different source for first  
page  
Watermark  
Overlay  
Double-sided printing  
(duplex)a  
a.The machine with duplex feature prints both side of a paper.  
( : Supported, Blank: Not supported)  
Printing_ 1  
   
Canceling a print job  
Basic printing  
If the print job is waiting in a print queue or print spooler, cancel the job as  
follows:  
Your machine allows you to print from various Windows, Macintosh, Linux  
or UNIX applications. The exact steps for printing a document may vary  
depending on the application you use.  
1. Click the Windows Start menu.  
2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
Your Printing Preferences window that appears in this user’s guide  
may differ depending on the machine in use. However, the  
composition of the Printing Preferences window is similar. Check  
the operating system(s) that are compatible with your machine  
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and  
Sound > Printers.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Devices and Printers.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
When you select an option in Printing Preferences, you may see a  
warning mark,  
, or  
. An exclamation mark ( ) means you  
Devices and Printers.  
3. For Windows 2000, XP, 2003, Vista and 2008, double-click your  
can select that certain option but it is not recommended, and (  
mark means you cannot select that option due to the machine’s  
setting or environment.  
)
machine.  
For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, right click your printer  
icon > context menus > See what’s printing.  
The following procedure describes the general steps required for  
printing from various Windows applications.  
If See what’s printing item has mark, you can select other  
printer drivers connected with selected printer.  
Macintosh basic printing (See "Macintosh printing" on page 9).  
Linux basic printing (See "Linux printing" on page 10).  
UNIX basic printing (See "UNIX printing" on page 12).  
4. From the Document menu, select Cancel.  
You can also access this window by simply double-clicking the  
The following Printing Preferences window is for Notepad in Windows XP.  
Your Printing Preferences window may differ, depending on your  
operating system or the application you are using.  
machine icon (  
) in the Windows task bar.  
You can also cancel the current job by pressing Stop/Clear on the  
control panel.  
1. Open the document you want to print.  
2. Select Print from the File menu. The Print window appears.  
3. Select your machine from the Select Printer list.  
Opening printing preferences  
You can preview the settings you selected on the upper right of the Printing  
Preferences.  
The following windows may differ, depending on your operating  
system , printer models or the application you are using.  
1. Open the document you want to print.  
2. Select Print from the file menu. The Print window appears.  
3. Select your machine from the Select Printer.  
The basic print settings including the number of copies and print range  
are selected within the Print window.  
To take advantage of the printer features provided by your printer  
driver, click Properties or Preferences in the application’s Print  
window to change the print setting (See "Opening printing  
4. To start the print job, click OK or Print in the Print window.  
The PostScript driver is recommended for best print image quality  
from PostScript-based applications such as Acrobat Reader®,  
Adobe Illustrator®, Adobe Photoshop®, etc.  
If you are using Windows Internet Explorer, the Samsung AnyWeb  
Print too will save your time for screen-captured images or printing  
the image. Click Start > All programs > Samsung Printers >  
your machine name > Samsung AnyWeb > Download the  
lastest version to link the website where the tool is available for  
the download.  
Printing_ 2  
     
4. Click Properties or Preferences.  
Using help  
Click the question mark from the upper-right corner of the window and click  
on any option you want to know about. Then a pop up window appears with  
information about that option's feature which is provided from the driver.  
If you want to search information via a keyword, click the Samsung tab in  
the Printing Preferences window, and enter a keyword in the input line of  
the Help option. To get information about supplies, driver update or  
registration and so on, click appropriate buttons.  
Using special print features  
Special print features include:  
Using a favorite setting  
The Presets option, which is visible on each preferences tab except for  
Samsung tab, allows you to save the current preferences settings for future  
use.  
To save a Presets item:  
Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper  
1. Change the settings as needed on each tab.  
2. Enter a name for the item in the Presets input box. Click Add.  
You can select the number of pages to print on a single sheet of paper. To  
print more than one page per sheet, the pages will be reduced in size and  
arranged in the order you specify. You can print up to 16 pages on one  
sheet.  
1. To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2).  
2. Click the Basic tab, select Multiple Pages Per Side in the Type  
drop-down list.  
3. Select the number of pages you want to print per sheet (2, 4, 6, 9, or 16)  
in the Pages per Side drop-down list.  
4. Select the page order from the Page Order drop-down list, if necessary.  
5. Check Print Page Border to print a border around each page on the  
sheet.  
6. Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source and Type.  
7. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
3. When you save Presets, all current driver settings are saved.  
If you click Add, the Add button changes to Update button. Select more  
options and click Update, settings will be added to the Presets you made.  
To use a saved setting, select it from the Presets drop down list. The  
Printing posters  
This feature allows you to print a single-page document onto 4, 9, or 16  
sheets of paper, for the purpose of pasting the sheets together to form one  
poster-size document.  
machine is now set to print according to the setting you selected.  
To delete saved setting, select it from the Presets drop down list and click  
Delete.  
You can also restore the printer driver’s default settings by selecting Default  
Preset from the Presets drop down list.  
Printing_ 3  
             
1. To change the print settings from your software application, access  
1. To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2)  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2).  
2. Click the Basic tab, select Poster Printing in the Type drop-down list.  
3. Select the page layout you want.  
2. Click the Basic tab.  
3. From the Double-Sided Printing section, select the binding option you  
want.  
Specification of the page layout:  
Printer Default: If you select this option, this feature is determined by  
the setting you’ve made on the control panel of the machine.  
None  
Poster 2x2: Document will be enlarged and be divided into 4 pages.  
Poster 3x3: Document will be enlarged and be divided into 9 pages.  
Poster 4x4: Document will be enlarged and be divided into 16 pages.  
Long Edge: This option is the conventional layout used in  
4. Select the Poster Overlap value. Specify Poster Overlap in millimeters  
or inches by selecting the radio button on the upper right of Basic tab to  
make it easier to paste the sheets together.  
bookbinding.  
Short Edge: This option is the conventional layout used in calendars.  
5. Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source and Type.  
6. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
7. You can complete the poster by pasting the sheets together.  
Printing booklets  
This feature prints your document on both sides of a paper and arranges the  
pages so that the paper can be folded in half after printing to produce a  
booklet.  
Reverse Double-Sided Printing: Check this option to reverse the  
print order when duplex printing.  
4. Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source and Type.  
If you want to make a booklet, you need to print on Letter, Legal, A4,  
US Folio, or Oficio sized print media.  
5. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
9
Change percentage of your document  
You can change the size of a document to appear larger or smaller on the  
printed page by typing in a percentage you want.  
8
1. To change the print settings from your software application, access the  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2).  
2. Click the Basic tab, select Booklet Printing from the Type drop-down  
list.  
1. To change the print settings from your software application, access  
3. Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source and Type.  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2).  
The Booklet Printing option is not available for all paper sizes. In  
order to find out the available paper size for this feature, select the  
available paper size in the Size option on the Paper tab.  
If you select an unavailable paper size, this option can be  
automatically canceled. Select only available paper. (paper without  
2. Click the Paper tab.  
3. Enter the scaling rate in the Percentage input box.  
You can also click the up/down arrows to select the scaling rate.  
4. Select the Size, Source and Type in Paper Options.  
5. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
or  
mark).  
4. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
5. After printing, fold and staple the pages.  
Fitting your document to a selected paper size  
This printer feature allows you to scale your print job to any selected paper  
size regardless of the document size. This can be useful when you want to  
check fine details on a small document.  
Printing on both sides of paper  
You can print on both sides of a paper; duplex. Before printing, decide how  
you want your document oriented. You can use this feature with Letter,  
Legal, A4, US Folio, or Oficio sized paper.  
A
We recommend not to print on both sides of the special media, such  
as labels, envelopes, or thick paper to print on both sides of paper. It  
may cause a paper jam or damage the machine.  
Printing_ 4  
         
1. To change the print settings from your software application, access  
5.Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2).  
2. Click the Paper tab.  
Deleting a watermark  
1.To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2).  
3. Select the paper size you want from the Fit to Page.  
4. Select the Size, Source and Type in Paper Options.  
5. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
2.Click the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-down  
list. The Edit Watermarks window appears.  
3.Select the watermark you want to delete from the Current  
Watermarks list and click Delete.  
4.Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
Using watermarks  
The watermark option allows you to print text over an existing document.  
For example, you use it when you want to have large gray letters reading  
DRAFT” or “CONFIDENTIAL” printed diagonally across the first page or all  
pages of a document.  
Using overlay (PCL driver only)  
An overlay is text and/or images stored in the computer hard disk drive  
(HDD) as a special file format that can be printed on any document.  
Overlays are often used to take the place of letterhead paper. Rather than  
using preprinted letterhead, you can create an overlay containing exactly  
the same information that is currently on your letterhead. To print a letter  
with your company’s letterhead, you do not need to load preprinted  
letterhead paper in the machine just print the letterhead overlay on your  
document.  
There are several predefined watermarks that come with the machine. They  
can be modified, or you can add new ones to the list.  
Using an existing watermark  
1.To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2).  
2.Click the Advanced tab and select the desired watermark from the  
Watermark drop-down list. You will see the selected watermark in  
the preview image.  
Creating a new page overlay  
To use a page overlay, you must create a new page overlay containing  
your logo or image.  
3.Click OK or Print until you exit the print window.  
Creating a watermark  
1.To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2).  
2.From the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-down  
list. The Edit Watermarks window appears.  
3.Enter a text message in the Watermark Message box. You can enter  
1.Create or open a document containing text or an image for use in a  
new page overlay. Position the items exactly as you wish them to  
appear when printed as an overlay.  
2.To save the document as an overlay, access Printing Preferences  
3.Click the Advanced tab, and select Edit from the Text drop-down list.  
Edit Overlay window appears.  
4.In the Edit Overlay window, click Create.  
5.In the Save As window, type a name of up to eight characters in the  
File name box. Select the destination path, if necessary. (The  
default is C:\Formover.)  
6.Click Save. The name appears on the Overlay List.  
7.Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
up to 256 characters. The message displays in the preview window.  
When the First Page Only box is checked, the watermark prints on  
the first page only.  
4.Select watermark options.  
You can select the font name, style, size and shade from the Font  
Attributes section, as well as set the angle of the watermark from  
the Message Angle section.  
8.The file is not printed. Instead, it is stored on your computer hard disk  
5.Click Add to add a new watermark to the Current Watermarks list.  
6.When you have finished editing, click OK or Print until you exit the  
drive.  
Print window.  
The overlay document size must be the same as the document  
you print with the overlay. Do not create an overlay with a  
watermark.  
To stop printing the watermark, select None from the Watermark  
drop-down list.  
Using a page overlay  
Editing a watermark  
After an overlay has been created, it is ready to be printed with your  
document. To print an overlay with a document:  
1.To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2).  
1.Create or open the document you want to print.  
2.Click the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-down  
list. The Edit Watermarks window appears.  
3.Select the watermark you want to edit from the Current Watermarks  
2.To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2).  
list and change the watermark message and options.  
3.Click the Advanced tab.  
4.Click Update to save the changes.  
4.Select the desired overlay from the Text drop-down list.  
Printing_ 5  
       
5.If the overlay file you want does not appear in the Text drop-down list,  
select Edit from the list and click Load. Select the overlay file you  
want to use.  
Adjusting color  
If you feel the color difference between the printout and monitor, you  
may change the color setting such as color contrast or color level.  
The printer driver provides graphic options to adjust the print quality for  
specific printing needs.  
If you have stored the overlay file you want to use in an external  
source, you can also load the file when you access the Load  
window.  
After you select the file, click Open. The file appears in the Overlay  
List box and is available for printing. Select the overlay from the  
Overlay List box.  
If the option is grayed out or not shown, that option is not  
applicable with the printer language you are using.  
This options you can select may vary depending on your printer  
model.  
6.If necessary, check Confirm Page Overlay When Printing box. If this  
box is checked, a message window appears each time you submit a  
document for printing, asking you to confirm your wish to print an  
overlay on your document.  
1.To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2).  
2.Click the Graphics tab. Refer to the online help for each option’s  
If this box is not checked and an overlay has been selected, the  
overlay automatically prints with your document.  
information provided from the Printing Preferences.  
Color Mode: You can choose color options between Color or  
Grayscale. Setting to Color typically produces the best possible  
print quality for color document. If you want to print a color  
document in gray scale, select Grayscale.  
7.Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
The selected overlay prints on your document.  
The resolution of the overlay document must be the same as that  
of the document you will print with the overlay.  
BlackOptimization allows you to print in high quality black.  
Deleting a page overlay  
If you use this option, it might take longer to print.  
You can delete page overlays that you no longer use.  
1.In the Printing Preferences window, click the Advanced tab.  
2.Select Edit in the Overlay drop down list.  
3.Select the overlay you want to delete from the Overlay List box.  
4.Click Delete.  
To adjust color manually, select Advanced in Color Mode.  
Simply slide the color balance slider in the Levels tab to adjust  
color, or select Matching tab for driver provided color correction  
for general image processing.  
Font/ Text: Select Darken Text to print texts darker than on a  
normal document. Use All Text Black to prints solid black,  
regardless of the color it appears on the screen.  
5.When a confirming message window appears, click Yes.  
6.Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
You can set advanced settings by clicking the Advanced button.  
-True Type Options: This option determines what the driver  
tells the printer about how to image the text in your  
document. Select the appropriate setting according to the  
status of your document.  
Job Setting (CLX-6250 Series only)  
This option allows you to choose how to print the printing file by using the  
512 MB optional memory or hard disk.  
Store, Spool, Normal, Proof and Print Schedule mode is available  
only if you have installed the optional hard disk.  
-Use Printer Fonts: When Use Printer Fonts is checked,  
the printer uses the fonts that are stored in its memory  
(resident fonts) to print your document, rather than  
downloading the fonts used in your document. Because  
downloading fonts takes time, selecting this option can  
speed up your printing time. When using Printer fonts, the  
printer will try to match the fonts used in your document to  
those stored in its memory. If, however, you use fonts in  
your document that are very different from those resident  
in the printer, your printed output will appear very different  
from what it looks like on the screen.  
Print Mode: The default Print Mode is Normal, which is for printing  
without saving the printing file in the memory.  
-Normal: This mode prints without storing your document in the  
optional memory.  
-Proof: This mode is useful when you print more than one copy. You  
can print one copy first to check, then print the rest of copies later.  
-Confidential: This mode is used for printing confidential document.  
You need to enter a password to print.  
Raster Compression: This option determines the compression  
level of images for transferring data from computer to a printer. If  
you set this option to Maximum, the printing speed will be high,  
but the printing quality will be low. (PCL driver only)  
Graphic Controller: It allows user to emphasize edges of texts  
and fine lines for improving readability and align each color  
channel registration in color printing mode.  
-Store: Select this setting to save a document in the hard disk without  
printing.  
-Spool: This option can be useful to handle large amount of data. If you  
select this setting, the print spools the document into the hard disk  
and then prints it from the hard disk queue, decreasing the  
computer’s work load.  
-Print Schedule: Select this setting to print the document at a specified  
-Grayscale Enhancement: It allows users to preserve the  
details of nature photos, and improve contrast and readability  
among gray scaled colors, when printing color documents in  
grayscale. (PCL driver only)  
time.  
User ID: This option is used when you need to find a saved file using  
the control panel.  
Job Name: This option is used when you need to find a saved file using  
the control panel.  
-Fine Edge: It allows users to emphasize edges of texts and fine  
lines for improving readability.  
Toner Save: Selecting this option extends the life of your toner  
cartridge and reduces your cost per page without a significant  
reduction in print quality.  
Graphics tab options  
Use the following Graphics options to adjust the print quality for your  
specific printing needs.  
3.Select Apply after completing the settings.  
Printing_ 6  
   
Output Option: This option allows you to select the output format for  
PostScript files.  
-Optimize for Speed: General format for PostScript files.  
-Optimize for Portability: Creates a file that conforms to the Adobe  
Document Structuring Conventions (ADSC). This is a useful format  
to use when you want to create a PostScript file and print it on a  
different machine.  
-Encapsulated PostScript(EPS): Creates a file as a image. This is a  
useful format to use if you want include the file as an image in  
another document that will be printed from a different program.  
Adjusting the sharpness and smoothness  
Screen options  
This option affect the resolution and clarity of your color output. The  
three screen options are Normal, Enhanced and Detailed.  
1.To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2).  
2.Click the Graphics tab then select Advanced in Color Mode.  
3.Select the Matching tab.  
-Archive Format: Creates a PostScript file you can use it later.  
Printer default: Follows the set value of Screen mode from the  
printer.  
PostScript Language: This option allows you to choose the PostScript  
language level.  
Send PostScript Error Handler: If this options is checked, the  
Normal: This mode will generate printouts with smooth tone over  
the entire page.  
machine prints an error page when an error occurs during printing.  
Enhanced: This mode will generate printouts with sharp texts and  
smooth graphic/photo objects in the page.  
Detailed: This mode will generate printouts with sharp details over  
the entire page.  
4.Select OK.  
Using direct printing utility (CLX-6250 Series  
only)  
This chapter explains how to use the Direct Printing Utility to print PDF files  
without having to open the files.  
Enhancing glossiness (Windows only)  
You can enhance the glossiness of the printout by using this feature.  
Hard disk drive (HDD) should be installed on your machine, to print  
PDF files using this program.  
You cannot print PDF files that are restricted to print. Deactivate the  
printing restriction feature, and retry printing.  
You cannot print PDF files that are protected by a password.  
Deactivate the password feature, and retry printing.  
Whether or not a PDF file can be printed using the Direct Printing  
Utility program depends on how the PDF file was created.  
You can only print on one side of paper with this option.  
If you use this option, it might take longer to print.  
1. To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 2).  
2. Click the Basic tab.  
3. Check Glossy Printing in Quality.  
4. Select OK.  
The Direct Printing Utility program supports the PDF version 1.4 and  
below. For a higher version, you must open the file to print it.  
Postscript options  
What is Direct Printing Utility?  
Direct Printing Utility is a program that sends a PDF file directly to your  
machine to print without having to open the file. It sends data through the  
Windows spooler using the port of the printer driver. It only supports PDF  
format.  
To install this program, select Custom installation and put a check mark in  
this program when you install the printer driver.  
Printing  
There are several ways you can print using the Direct Printing Utility.  
From the Direct Printing Utility window  
1.From the Start menu select Programs or All Programs > Samsung  
Printers > Direct Printing Utility > Direct Printing Utility.  
Or, double-click the Direct Printing Utility shortcut icon on your  
desktop.  
The Direct Printing Utility window opens.  
2.Select your machine from the Select Printer drop-down list and click  
Browse.  
3.Select the PDF file you wish to print and click Open.  
The PDF file is added in the Selected Files section.  
4.Customize the machine settings for your needs.  
5.Click Print. The selected PDF file is sent to the machine.  
The following windows may differ, depending on your operating  
system , printer models or the application you are using.  
Following options are only supported on the Post Script driver.  
Open the Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
page 2). Then click Graphic tab > PostScript Options.  
Printing_ 7  
     
printer drivers connected with selected printer.  
Using the shortcut icon  
1. Select the PDF file you wish to print, drag and drop it to the Direct Printing  
Utility shortcut icon on your desk top. The selected PDF file is sent to the  
default machine.  
Printing to a file (PRN)  
You will sometimes need to save the print data as a file.  
To create a file:  
If the default machine does not support Direct Printing Utility, the  
message window alerting you to select the appropriate machine  
opens. Select the appropriate machine in the Select Printer section.  
1. Check the Print to file box at the Print window.  
2. Customize the machine settings for your needs.  
3. Click Print. The selected PDF file is sent to the machine.  
Using the right-click menu  
1. Right-click on the PDF file you wish to print and select Direct Printing  
Utility.  
The Direct Printing Utility window opens with the PDF file is added.  
2. Select the machine you wish to use.  
3. Customize the machine settings for your needs.  
4. Click Print. The selected PDF file is sent to the machine.  
Changing the default print settings  
1. Click the Windows Start menu.  
2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
2. Click Print.  
3. Type in the destination path and the file name, and then click OK.  
For example c:\Temp\file name.  
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Printers.  
If you type in only the file name, the file is automatically saved in My  
Documents.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices  
and Printers.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Devices and Printers.  
3. Right-click your machine.  
Using the job accounting option  
This option allows you to print with the given permission.  
4. For Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, press Printing Preferences.  
2. Click the Windows Start menu.  
3. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select  
the Printing preferences.  
If Printing preferences item has mark, you can select other  
printer drivers connected with selected printer.  
5. Change the settings on each tab.  
6. Click OK.  
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Printers.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices  
If you want to change the settings for each print job, change it in  
Printing Preferences.  
and Printers.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Devices and Printers.  
4. Right-click your machine.  
Setting your machine as a default machine  
1. Click the Windows Start menu.  
2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
5. For Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, press Properties.  
For PS driver, select PS driver and right-click to open Properties.  
For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select  
the Printer properties.  
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Printers.  
If Printer properties item has mark, you can select other printer  
drivers connected with selected printer.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices  
and Printers.  
6. In printer driver properties, select Device Options.  
7. Click Job Accounting and select one of the options.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Devices and Printers.  
User permission: If you check this option, only users with user  
permission can start a print job.  
Group permission: If you check this option, only groups with group  
3. Select your machine.  
4. Right-click your machine and select Set as Default Printer.  
For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2  
If Set as default printer item has mark, you can select other  
permission can start a print job.  
Printing_ 8  
         
or the application you are using.  
If you want to encrypt job accounting password, check Job  
The following pane is the first pane you will see when you open the printer  
properties pane. Select other advanced features from the drop down list.  
Accounting Password Encryption.  
Administrators can enable job accounting and configure  
permissions in SyncThru™ Web Admin Service.  
8. Click OK until you exit the Printer properties window.  
Macintosh printing  
This section explains how to print using Macintosh. You need to set the print  
environment before printing.  
USB connected (See "Macintosh" on page 4).  
Network connected (See "Macintosh" on page 5).  
Printing a document  
When you print with a Macintosh, you need to check the printer driver  
setting in each application you use. Follow the steps below to print from a  
Macintosh:  
Layout  
The Layout tab provides options to adjust how the document appears  
on the printed page. You can print multiple pages on one sheet of paper.  
Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation to access the  
following features.  
1. Open the document you want to print.  
2. Open the File menu and click Page Setup (Document Setup in some  
applications).  
Pages Per Sheet: This option determines how many pages to be  
3. Choose your paper size, orientation, scaling, other options and make  
sure that your machine is selected. Click OK.  
Layout Direction: This option allows you to select the printing  
direction on a page similar to the examples on UI.  
Border: This option allows you to print a border around each page on  
the sheet.  
Two-Sided: This option allows you to print on both sides of a paper  
Reverse Page Orientation: This option allows you to rotate paper 180  
degrees.  
Graphics  
The Graphics tab provides options for selecting Quality. Select  
Graphics from the drop-down list under Orientation to access the  
graphic features.  
4. Open the File menu and click Print.  
5. Choose the number of copies you want and indicate which pages you  
want to print.  
6. Click Print.  
Quality: This option allows you to select the printing resolution. The  
higher the setting, the sharper the clarity of printed characters and  
graphics. The higher setting also may increase the time it takes to  
print a document.  
Color Mode: You can set the color options. Setting to Color typically  
produces the best possible print quality for color documents. If you  
want to print a color document in grayscale, select Grayscale.  
BlackOptimization: allows you to print in high quality black. If you use  
this option, it might take longer to print.  
Advanced  
Changing printer settings  
You can use advanced printing features provided by your machine.  
Open an application and select Print from the File menu. The machine  
name, which appears in the printer properties pane may differ depending on  
the machine in use. Except for the name, the composition of the printer  
properties pane is similar to the following.  
-Page Color Setting: This option allows you to print some pages in  
color and other pages in mono within a document. For example,  
if you want to print pages 1~4 in color and you have chosen  
Grayscale in the Graphic tab, select Color then type in 1-4.  
The setting options may differ depending on printers and Macintosh  
OS version.  
The following panes may differ, depending on your operating system  
Job Accounting  
This option allows you to print with the given permission.  
User permission: If you check this option, only users with user  
permission can start a print job.  
Group permission: If you check this option, only groups with group  
permission can start a print job.  
If you want to encrypt job accounting password, refer to help  
on the bottom left coner of the printer properties pane.  
Printing_ 9  
 
Administrators can enable job accounting and configure  
permissions in SyncThru™Web Admin Service.  
1. Open an application, and select Print from the File menu.  
2. Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation. In the Pages  
per Sheet drop-down list, select the number of pages you want to print  
on one sheet of paper.  
Job Setting (CLX-6250 Series only)  
This option allows you to choose how to print the printing file by using  
the 512 MB optional memory or Hard disk.  
Store, Spool, Normal and Print Schedule mode is available only  
if you have installed the optional hard disk.  
Print Mode: The default Print Mode is Normal, which is for printing  
without saving the printing file in the memory.  
-Normal: This mode prints without storing your document in the  
optional memory.  
-Confidential: This mode is used for printing confidential document.  
You need to enter a password to print.  
-Store: Select this setting to save a document in the hard disk  
without printing.  
-Spool: This option can be useful to handle large amount of data. If  
you select this setting, the print spools the document into the  
hard disk and then prints it from the hard disk queue, decreasing  
the computer’s work load.  
3. Select the other options you want to use.  
4. Click Print, then machine prints the selected number of pages you want  
to print on one sheet of paper.  
-Print Schedule: Select this setting to print the document at a  
specified time.  
Printing on both sides of paper  
You can print on both sides of the paper. Before printing in the duplex mode,  
decide on which edge you will be binding your finished document. The  
binding options are, as follows:  
User ID: This option is used when you need to find a saved file using  
the control panel.  
Job Name: This option is used when you need to find a saved file  
using the control panel.  
Long-Edge Binding: This option is the conventional layout used in  
book binding.  
Paper  
Short-Edge Binding: This option is the type often used with calendars.  
Set Paper Type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray from  
which you want to print. This will let you get the best quality printout. If  
you load a different type of print material, select the corresponding paper  
type.  
1. From your Macintosh application, select Print from the File menu.  
2. Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation.  
3. Select a binding orientation from Two Sided Printing option.  
4. Select the other options you want to use.  
Printer Features  
Reverse Duplex Printing: This option allows you to select general  
print order compared to duplex print order. If this option does not  
appear, your machine does not have this feature.  
5. Click Print, then the machine prints the selected number of pages on a  
side of a paper.  
Darken Text: Select this option to print texts darker than on a normal  
document.  
Fit to Page: This option allows you to scale your print job to any  
selected paper size regardless of the document size. This can be  
useful when you want to check fine details on a small document.  
RGB Color: This setting determines how colors are rendered.  
Standard is the most widely used setting which the color tone of this  
mode is the closest to that of standard monitor (sRGB Monitor).  
Vivid mode is appropriate for printing presentation data and charts.  
The color tone of Vivid mode produces more Vivid color images  
than that of Standard mode. Device mode is best used for printing  
fine lines, small characters and color drawings. The color tone of  
Device mode may be different from that of monitor, the pure toner  
colors are used for printing cyan, magenta and yellow colors.  
If you print more than 2 copies, the last page of the first copy and the  
first page of the second copy might print on same sheet of paper.  
Avoid using this feature when you are printing more than 1 copy.  
Screen: This option affect the resolution and clarity of your color  
output.  
Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper  
You can print more than one page on a single sheet of paper. This feature  
provides a cost-effective way to print draft pages.  
Linux printing  
Printing from applications  
The following windows may differ, depending on your operating  
Printing_ 10  
     
system , printer models or the application you are using.  
Printing files  
You can print many different types of files on your machine using the  
standard CUPS way, directly from the command line interface. The CUPS  
lpr utility allows you to do that. But the drivers package replaces the  
standard lpr tool by a much more user-friendly LPR GUI program.  
There are a lot of Linux applications that allow you to print using Common  
UNIX Printing System (CUPS). You can print on your machine from any  
such application.  
1. Open an application, and select Print from the File menu  
2. Select Print directly using lpr.  
3. In the LPR GUI window, select the model name of your machine from  
To print any document file:  
1. Type lpr <file_name> from the Linux shell command line and press  
Enter. The LPR GUI window appears.  
the printer list and click Properties.  
When you type only lpr and press Enter, the Select file(s) to print  
window appears first. Just select any files you want to print and click  
Open.  
2. In the LPR GUI window, select your machine from the list, and change  
the print job properties.  
3. Click OK to start printing.  
Configuring Printer Properties  
Using the Printer Properties window provided by the Printers  
configuration, you can change the various properties for your machine as  
a printer.  
1. Open the Unified Driver Configurator.  
If necessary, switch to Printers configuration.  
2. Select your machine on the available printers list and click Properties.  
3. The Printer Properties window opens.  
4. Change the print job properties using the following four tabs displayed at  
the top of the window.  
The following five tabs display at the top of the window:  
General: This option allows you to change the printer location and  
name. The name entered in this tab displays on the printer list in  
Printers configuration.  
Connection: This option allows you to view or select another port. If  
you change the machine port from USB to parallel or vice versa  
while in use, you must re-configure the machine port in this tab.  
Driver: This option allows you to view or select another machine  
General: This option allows you to change the paper size, the paper  
type and the orientation of the documents. It enables the duplex  
feature, adds start and end banners and changes the number of  
pages per sheet.  
driver. By clicking Options, you can set the default device options.  
Jobs: This option shows the list of print jobs. Click Cancel job to  
cancel the selected job and select the Show completed jobs check  
box to see previous jobs on the job list.  
Classes: This option shows the class that your machine is in. Click  
Add to Class to add your machine to a specific class or click  
Remove from Class to remove the machine from the selected  
class.  
Text: This option allows you to specify the page margins and set the  
text options, such as spacing or columns.  
Graphics: This option allows you to set image options that are used  
when printing image files, such as color options, image size, or  
image position.  
4. Click OK to apply the changes and close the Printer Properties  
Advanced: This option allows you to set the print resolution, paper  
window.  
source and special print features.  
5. Click Apply to apply the changes and close the Properties window.  
6. Click OK in the LPR GUI window to start printing.  
7. The Printing window appears, allowing you to monitor the status of your  
print job.  
To abort the current job, click Cancel.  
Printing_ 11  
General tab  
UNIX printing  
Paper Size: Set the paper size as A4, Letter or other paper sizes,  
according to your requirements.  
Paper Type: Choose the type of the paper. Options available in the list  
Proceeding the print job  
After installing the printer, choose any of the image, text, PS or HPGL files  
to print.  
box are Printer Default, Plain, and Thick.  
Paper Source: Select the source of the page. By default, it is Auto  
1. Execute “printui <file_name_to_print>” command.  
For example, you are printing “document1”  
printui document1  
Selection.  
Orientation: Select the direction in which information is printed on a  
page.  
This will open the UNIX Printer Driver Print Job Manager in which the  
user can select various print options.  
Duplex: Print on both sides of paper to save paper.  
Multiple pages: Print several pages on one side of paper.  
Page Border: Choose any of the border styles (e.g.: Single-line  
hairline, Double-line hairline)  
Image tab  
In this tab, you can change the brightness, resolution or an image  
position of your document.  
Text tab  
Set the character margin, line space or the columns of the actual print  
output.  
HPGL/2 tab  
Use only black pen: To print all graphics in black.  
Fit plot to page: Fit the entire graphic into a single page.  
Pen Width: Change value to increase the thickness of pen lines. By  
default, it is 1000.  
Margins tab  
Use Margins: Set the margins for the document. By default, margins  
are not enabled. The user can change the margin settings by  
changing the values in the respective fields. Set by default, these  
values depend on the page size selected.  
2. Select a printer which has been already added.  
3. Select the printing options from the window such as Page Selection.  
4. Select how many copies needed in Number of Copies.  
To take advantage of the printer features provided by your printer  
driver, press Properties (See "Changing the printer settings" on  
page 12).  
Unit: Change the units to points, inches or centimeters.  
Samsung Printer tab  
Select various options in the JCL and General frames to customize  
various settings. These options are specific to the printer and depend on  
the PPD file.  
5. Press OK to start the print job.  
Changing the printer settings  
The UNIX Printer Driver Print Job Manager in which the user can select  
various print options in printer Properties.  
The following hot keys may also be used: “H” for Help, “O” for OK and “A”  
for Apply and “C” for Cancel.  
Printing_ 12  
   
1.  
copying  
This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for copying documents.  
This chapter includes:  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
Basic copy  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Darkness and press OK.  
This is the normal and usual procedure for copying your originals.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the contrast mode you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
Lightest: Works well with darker print.  
Light: Works well with dark print.  
Normal: Works well with standard typed or printed originals.  
Dark: Works well with light print.  
Darkest: Works well with lighter print or faint pencil markings.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Selecting the type of originals  
The original type setting is used to improve the copy quality by selecting the  
document type for the current copy job.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Original Type and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the image mode you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
Text: Use for originals containing mostly text.  
Text/Photo: Use for originals with mixed text and photographs.  
Photo: Use when the originals are photographs.  
Magazine: Use when the originals are magazines.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
3. If necessary, adjust the settings for each copy such as Reduce/Enlarge,  
Darkness, Original Type and more (See "Changing the settings for  
4. Enter the number of copies using the arrow or number keypad, if  
necessary.  
5. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Selecting the scan size of originals  
You can choose the size to be scanned.  
To cancel the current copy job, press Stop/Clear on the control panel.  
The scan size options may vary between document feeder or scanner  
glass.  
Changing the settings for each copy  
Your machine provides default settings for copying so that you can quickly  
and easily make a copy. However, if you want to change the options for  
each copy, use the copy function buttons on the control panel.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan Size and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the scan size you want is highlighted and  
If you press Stop/Clear while setting the copy options, all of the  
options you have set for the current copy job will be canceled and  
return to their default status after the machine completes the copy in  
progress.  
press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Changing the darkness  
If you have an original containing faint marking and dark images, you can  
adjust the brightness to make a copy that is easier to read.  
Copying_ 1  
     
Reducing or enlarging copies  
You can reduce or enlarge the size of a copied image from 25% to 400%  
when you copy original documents from the scanner glass, or from 25% to  
100% from the document feeder.  
ID card copying  
Your machine can print 2-sided originals on one sheet of A4-, Letter-,  
Legal-, Folio-, Executive-, B5, A5, or A6-sized paper.  
The machine prints one side of the original on the upper half of the paper  
and the other side on the lower half without reducing the size of the original.  
This feature is helpful for copying a small-sized item, such as a business  
card.  
To select from the predefined copy sizes:  
1.Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2.Press Menu on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Reduce/Enlarge and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow until the size setting you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
6.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the  
scanner glass.  
To scale the copy by directly entering the scale rate:  
The size of the 2-sided originals should be smaller than A5, if not,  
some of it won’t be copied.  
1.Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
1. Press ID Copy on the control panel.  
2.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Place Front Side Press appears on the display.  
3. Place the front side of an original facing down on the scanner glass  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Reduce/Enlarge and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Custom and press OK.  
where arrows indicate as shown, and close the scanner lid.  
6.Press the up/down arrow or numeric keypad to enter the copy size you  
want. Pressing and holding the up/down arrow allows you to quickly  
scroll to the number you want.  
7.Press OK to save the selection.  
8.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
4. Press Start on the control panel.  
When you make a reduced copy, black lines may appear at the  
bottom of your copy.  
Your machine begins scanning the front side and shows Place Rear  
Side Press  
.
5. Turn the original over and place it on the scanner glass, where arrows  
Changing the default copy settings  
indicate as shown then, close the scanner lid.  
The copy options, including darkness, original type, copy size, collation and  
number of copies, can be set to those most frequently used. When you copy  
a document, the default settings are used unless they have been changed  
by using the corresponding buttons on the control panel.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
6. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Change Default and press OK.  
If the original is larger than the printable area, some portions may not  
be printed.  
If you press Stop/Clear, the machine cancles the copy job and  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the setup option you want is highlighted  
returns to ready mode.  
and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the setting you want is highlighted and  
Deciding the form of copy output  
press OK.  
You can set the machine to sort the copy job. For example, if you make 2  
copies of a 3 page original, one complete 3 page document will print  
followed by a second complete document.  
7. Repeat steps 5 through 6, as needed.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
While you are setting copy options, pressing Stop/Clear cancels the  
changed settings and restores the defaults.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
Using special copy features  
3. Press OK and enter the number of copies using the number keypad.  
4. Press Menu on the control panel.  
You can use the following copy features:  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Setup and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Change Default and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Collation and press OK.  
8. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
Copying_ 2  
     
On: Prints output in sets to match the sequence of originals.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Layout and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Poster Copy and press OK.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
8. Press Start to begin copying.  
Your original is divided into 9 portions. Each portion is scanned and  
printed one by one in the following order:  
Off: Prints output sorted into stacks of individual pages.  
9. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
10. Press Start to begin copying.  
One complete document will print followed by the second complete  
document.  
Clone copying  
The machine prints multiple original images on a single page. The number  
of images is automatically determined by the original image and the paper  
size.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner  
glass.  
2-up or 4-up copying (N-up)  
The machine reduces the size of the original images and prints 2 or 4 pages  
onto one sheet of paper.  
2 or 4-up copying is available only when you load originals into the  
document feeder.  
1
3
2
4
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Layout and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Clone Copy and press OK.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Layout and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until 2up or 4up highlights and press OK.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
8. Press Start to begin copying.  
You cannot adjust the copy size using Reduce/Enlarge for the Clone  
Copy feature.  
8. Press Start to begin copying.  
You cannot adjust the copy size using Reduce/Enlarge for the N-Up  
feature.  
Book copying  
The Book Copy feature allows you to copy an entire book. If the book is too  
thick, lift the cover until its hinges are caught by the stopper and then close  
the cover. If the book or magazine is thicker than 30 mm, start copying with  
the cover open.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner  
glass.  
Poster copying  
Your original will be divided into 9 portions. You can paste the printed pages  
together to make one poster-sized document.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner  
glass.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Layout and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Book Copy and press OK.  
2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Copying_ 3  
 
7. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want is highlighted.  
Off: Does not use this feature.  
Left Page: Use this option to print left page of the book.  
Right Page: Use this option to print right page of the book.  
Both Page: Use this option to print both pages of the book.  
8. Press OK.  
7. Press OK.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
9. Press Start to begin copying.  
Edge erase copying  
Edge erase allows you to erase spots, drill holes, fold creases and staple  
marks along any of the four edges of a document.  
9. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
10. Press Start to begin copying.  
The Edge Erase feature can either be used for scanner glass or  
document feeder depending on the set up.  
Small Original: Scanner glass  
Hole Punch: Scanner glass, Document feeder  
Book Center: Scanner glass  
Adjusting background images  
You can set the printer to print an image without its background. This copy  
feature removes the background color and can be helpful when copying an  
original containing color in the background, such as a newspaper or a  
catalog.  
Border Erase: Scanner glass, Document feeder  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Adjust Bkgd. and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want is highlighted.  
Off: Does not use this feature.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Auto: Optimizes the background.  
Enhance Lev.1 ~ 2: The higher the number is, the more vivid the  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Edge Erase and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want is highlighted.  
Off: Does not use this feature.  
background is.  
Erase Lev.1 ~ 4: The higher the number is, the lighter the background  
is.  
Small Original: Erases the edge of the original if it is small.  
Hole Punch: Erases the marks of bookbinding holes.  
Book Center: Erases the middle part of the paper which is black and  
7. Press OK.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
9. Press Start to begin copying.  
horizontal, when you copy a book.  
Border Erase: Erases the certain amount of the edge of the printout.  
7. Press OK.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
9. Press Start to begin copying.  
Margin shift copying  
The Margin Shift feature allows you to create a binding edge for the  
document. The image can be adjusted up or down on the page and/or  
shifted to the right or left.  
The Margin Shift feature can either be used for scanner glass or  
document feeder depending on the set up.  
Gray enhance copying  
When you copy the original in gray scale, use this feature for the better  
quality of copy-output. This feature is only for the copy in gray scale.  
Auto Center: Scanner glass  
Custom Margin: Scanner glass, Document feeder  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Gray Enhance and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to select On.  
7. Press OK.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
9. Press Start to begin copying.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Margin Shift and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want is highlighted.  
Off: Does not use this feature.  
Watermark copying  
You can copy the original with a watermark. For example, you can use it  
when you want to have large gray letters such as Top Secret or  
Confidential printed diagonally across the first page or all pages of the  
copy.  
Auto Center: Automatically copy in the center of the paper.  
Custom Margin: Enter the left, right, top, bottom margin using Number  
keypad.  
Copying_ 4  
printout is rotated 180°.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight WaterMark and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the binding Message option you want is  
5. Press OK to save your selection.  
6. Start copying a document.  
highlighted and OK.  
Setting copy timeout  
7. Press the up/down arrow until the binding Pages option you want is  
highlighted and OK.  
You can set the time the machine waits before it restores the default control  
panel settings, if you press Start button prior to the control panel restoring  
to default, the previous job will be reprinted.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
9. Press Start to begin copying.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Copying both sides of the originals  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Timeout and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the time setting you want is highlighted.  
You can set the machine to print copies on both sides of paper.  
The Duplex options may vary between document feeder or scanner  
glass.  
Selecting Off means that the machine does not restore the default  
settings until you press Start to begin copying, or Stop/Clear to cancel.  
6. Press OK to save the selection.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Duplex on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want is highlighted.  
Off: Prints in normal mode.  
1->2Side Short: Prints pages to be read by flipping like a note pad.  
2
3
5
1->2Side Long: Prints pages to be read like a book.  
2->1Side: Scans both sides of the originals and prints each of one on a  
separate sheet.  
2->2Side: Scans both sides of the original and prints on both sides of  
the paper. This function produces exactly the same print out from the  
originals.  
2->1Side ROT2: Scans both sides of the original and prints each one  
on a separate sheet, but the information on the back side of the  
Copying_ 5  
   
1.  
scanning  
Scanning with your machine lets you turn pictures and text into digital files that can be stored on your computer.  
This chapter includes:  
The maximum resolution that can be achieved depends upon various  
factors, including computer speed, available disk space, memory, the  
size of the image being scanned, and bit depth settings. Thus,  
depending on your system and what you are scanning, you may not  
be able to scan at certain resolutions, especially using enhanced  
resolution.  
Scanning originals and sending through email  
(Scan to Email)  
You can scan the originals and email the scanned image to several  
destinations from the machine by email.  
Setting up an email account  
To scan and send an image as an email attachment, you need to set up  
network parameters using SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Basic scanning method  
You can scan the originals with your machine via an USB cable or the  
network. The following methodoloqies can be used for scanning your  
documents:  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
4. Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.  
A log-in page appears.  
Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: Scan the originals from the control  
panel. Then, the scanned data will be stored in the connected  
computers My Documents folder. When you install all the software in  
the supplied CD, the Samsung Scan and Fax Manager is also  
automatically installed on your computer. This feature can be used via  
the local connection or the network connection (See "Using Samsung  
5. Type in the ID and Password then click Login .  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
TWAIN: TWAIN is the one of a preset imaging applications. Scanning  
an image launches the selected application, enabling you to control the  
scanning process. This feature can be used via the local connection or  
the network connection (See "Scanning with TWAIN-enabled software"  
SmarThru Office : This program is the accompanying software for your  
machine. You can use this program to scan images or documents. This  
feature can be used via the local connection or the network connection  
Password: sec00000  
6. Click Settings > Network Settings and Outgoing Mail Server(SMTP).  
7. Enter the IP address in dotted decimal notation or as a host name.  
8. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535.  
The default port number is 25.  
9. Check the box next to SMTP Requires Authentication to require  
authentication.  
10. Enter the SMTP server login name and password.  
WIA: WIA stands for Windows Images Acquisition. To use this feature,  
your computer must be connected directly with the machine via an USB  
USB Memory: You can scan a document and save the scanned image  
onto an USB memory device (See "Scanning to an USB memory  
Email: You can send the scanned image as an email attachment (See  
page 1).  
FTP: You can scan an image and upload it to an FTP server (See  
page 4).  
11. Click Apply.  
If the authentication method of SMTP server is POP3 before SMTP,  
put a check mark of SMTP Requires POP3 Before SMTP  
Authentication.  
a) Enter the IP address in dotted decimal notation or as a host name.  
b)Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535. The default port  
number is 110.  
SMB: You can scan an image and send it to a shared folder on an SMB  
Scanning_ 1  
   
Storing on your local machine  
This method means that you store email addresses on your machine’s  
memory. You can add addresses, as well as group them in particular  
categories.  
Sending a scanned image to several destinations as  
an email attachment  
1. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass  
Individual  
1.Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2.Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a browser.  
3.Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
4.Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service  
website.  
A log-in page appears.  
5.Type in the ID and Password then click Login.  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
Password: sec00000  
6.Click Address Book > Individual.  
7.Click Add.  
2. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
8.When the Add screen appears, select the Speed No. number and  
enter e-mail address and fax number.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan To Email and press OK.  
If you need to set SMB or FTP sever information, check SMB  
or FTP and set the information.  
If you registered My Log in ID, Password and checked Local  
Authentication in User Access Control on SyncThru™ Web  
Service, Login Name and Enter Password appear. Enter the  
Auth ID and Password to your machine. Go to step 5.  
9.Click Apply.  
Group  
4. When From: appears on the top line of the display, enter the sender’s  
1.Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2.Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a browser.  
3.Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
email address and press OK.  
5. When Destination Email: appears on the top line of the display, enter  
the recipient’s email address and press OK.  
6. To enter additional addresses, press the left/right arrow to highlight Yes  
4.Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service  
website.  
A log-in page appears.  
5.Type in the ID and Password then click Login.  
and press OK.  
To continue to the next step, press the left/right arrow to highlight No  
and press OK.  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
7. If the displays asks if you want to send the email to your account, press  
the left/right arrow to highlight Yes or No and press OK.  
ID: admin  
Password: sec00000  
6.Make sure you have configured individual address book.  
7.Click Address Book > E-mail Group .  
8.Click Add Group.  
This prompt does not appear if you have activated the Auto Send  
To Self option in the Settings > Scan > Scan To E-mail on  
SyncThru™ Web Service.  
8. Enter an email subject and press OK.  
9. Press the up/down arrow until the file type you want is highlighted and  
9.When the Add Group screen appears, select the Speed No. number  
press OK.  
and enter Group Name.  
When you have finished, select No when Another Page? appears.  
The machine begins scanning and then sends the email.  
You can easily add individual address if you check Yes for Add  
individual(s) after this group is created.  
While the machine is sending an email, you cannot use the  
machine to copy or to send a fax.  
10.Click Apply.  
10. Press the Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Searching Address Book for an entry  
There are two ways to search for an address in memory. You can either  
scan from 0 to 199 sequentially or search by entering the first letters of  
the name associated with the address.  
Storing email addresses  
You can set up Address Book with the email addresses you use frequently  
via SyncThru™ Web Service and then easily and quickly enter email  
addresses by entering the location numbers assigned to them in Address  
Book.  
Searching sequentially through memory  
1.Press  
(Scan/Email) and Address Book on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Search & Dial and press OK.  
Scanning_ 2  
 
3.Press the up/down arrow until the option you want highlights and press  
Scan Format appears only when you selected the Scan  
OK.  
destination to My Documents.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight All and press OK.  
If you want to scan from the default setting, press Start.  
5.Press the up/down arrow until the name and address you want is  
highlighted. You can search upwards or downwards through the  
entire memory in index (numerical) order.  
8. Scanning begins.  
Scanned image is saved in computer’s My Documents > My  
Pictures > Samsung folder.  
Searching with a particular first letter  
1.Press  
(Scan/Email) and Address Book on the control panel.  
You can use Twain driver to scan quickly in Samsung Scan and  
Fax Manager program.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Search & Dial and press OK.  
You can also scan by pressing Window’s Start > Control Panel >  
3.Press the up/down arrow until the option you want is highlighted and  
Samsung Scan and Fax Manager > Quick Scan.  
press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight ID and press OK.  
5.Enter the first few letters of the name you want.  
For network connected machine  
Make sure the scanner printer driver is installed on your computer using the  
software CD, since the printer driver includes the scan program it does not  
need to be installed separartely in most cases (See "Installing network  
6.Press the up/down arrow until the name you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
Printing Address Book  
1. Make sure that your machine and the computer are connected to a  
network and Samsung Scan and Fax Manager is installed on the  
computer.  
You can check your Address Book information by printing a list.  
1.Press  
(Scan/Email) and Address Book on the control panel.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Print and press OK.  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
3.Press the up/down arrow until the option you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
3. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
Your Address Book information prints out.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan To PC and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Network PC and press OK.  
Scanning originals and sending to your  
computer (Scan to PC)  
If you see Not Available message, check the port connection.  
6. Select your registered computer ID, and enter the Password if  
You can scan an image on the machine via the Samsung Scan and Fax  
Manager program that is installed in your networked computer.  
necessary.  
ID is the same ID as the registered Computer ID for Samsung  
Scan and Fax Manager.  
Password is the 4 digit number registered Password for  
For USB connected machine  
This is a basic scanning method for usb connected machine.  
Samsung Scan and Fax Manager.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
7. Press the up/down arrow until the application program you want  
on.  
highlights and press OK.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
Default setting is My Documents.  
original face down on the scanner glass  
To add or delete the folder where the scanned file is saved, add or  
delete the application program in Samsung Scan and Fax  
Manager > Properties > Set Scan Button.  
3. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan To PC and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Local PC and press OK.  
8. Press the up/down arrow until the setting you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
Resolution: Sets the image resolution.  
Scan Color: Sets the color mode.  
Scan Format: Sets the file format in which the image is to be saved.  
Scan Size: Sets the image size.  
If you see Not Available message, check the port connection.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the application program you want is  
highlighted and press OK.  
Default setting is My Documents.  
Scan Format appears only when you selected the Scan  
To add or delete the folder where the scanned file is saved, add or  
delete the application program in Samsung Scan and Fax  
Manager > Properties > Set Scan Button.  
destination to My Documents.  
If you want to scan from the default setting, press Start.  
9. Scanning begins.  
7. Press the up/down arrow until the setting you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
Resolution: Sets the image resolution.  
Scanned image is saved in computer’s My Documents > My  
Pictures > Samsung folder.  
Scan Color: Sets the color mode.  
Scan Format: Sets the file format in which the image is to be saved.  
Scan Size: Sets the image size.  
You can use Twain driver to scan quickly in using the Samsung  
Scan and Fax Manager program.  
You can also scan by pressing Window’s Start > Control Panel >  
Scanning_ 3  
 
Samsung Scan and Fax Manager > Quick Scan.  
12. Check the box next to Anonymous if you want to permit unauthorized  
persons to access the SMB server.  
This box is unchecked by default.  
13. Enter the Login Name and Password.  
14. Enter the Domain. If your server is joined to the certain domain, and you  
are using the domain account to log in, enter the domain name.  
Otherwise, just enter your computer name which is registered to the  
SMB server.  
Scanning originals and sending via SMB/FTP  
(Scan to server)  
You can scan an image and send it to a total of five destinations via the  
SMB or FTP.  
15. Enter the Path for saving the scanned image. The folder (e.g. Scanned  
Images) must be setup on the root and the folder properties need to be  
setup as a share, with you listed as having user rights to the folder.  
Setting up an FTP server  
To use an FTP server, you need to set up parameters to access the FTP  
servers using SyncThru™ Web Service.  
16. Click Apply.  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a your web browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
4. Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.  
A log-in page appears.  
Scanning and sending to SMB/FTP server  
1. Make sure that your machine is connected to a network.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
5. Type in the ID and Password then click Login.  
3. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan To SMB or Scan To FTP,  
and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight the server and file share required  
Password: sec00000  
then press OK.  
6. Click Address Book > Individual.  
7. Click Add.  
8. Check the box next to Add FTP.  
9. Enter the server address in dotted decimal notation or a host name.  
10. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535.  
The default port number is 21.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the scan format you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
The machine begins scanning and then sends the scanned image to the  
specified server.  
Setting authentication for authorized user  
11. Check the box next to Anonymous if you want the FTP server to permit  
access to unauthorized people.  
If you have connected your machine to a network and set up the network  
parameters correctly, you can scan and send images over the network.  
This box is unchecked by default.  
12. Enter the Login Name and Password.  
13. Enter the Path for saving the scanned image.  
14. Click Apply.  
To send a scanned image through email or via network server safely, you  
must register account information of authorized users to your local machine  
using SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Setting up an SMB server  
Registering local authorized users  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in your web browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
4. Click Security > User Access Control > User Authentication.  
5. Select Local Authentication in the Authentication Method section.  
6. Click Apply.  
To use an SMB server, you need to set up parameters for access to SMB  
servers using SyncThru™ Web Service.  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a your web browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
4. Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.  
A log-in page appears.  
7. Click OK in the modifying confirmation pop-up window.  
8. Click User Profile.  
5. Type in the ID and Password then click Login.  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
ID: admin  
9. Click Add.  
10. Enter User Name, Login ID, Password, E-mail Address and Fax  
Number.  
Password: sec00000  
6. Click Address Book > Individual.  
7. Click Add.  
You need to enter the registered user ID and password in the machine  
when you start scanning to email from the control panel.  
11. Click Apply.  
8. Check the box next to Add SMB.  
9. Enter the server address in dotted decimal notation or a host name.  
10. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535.  
The default port number is 139.  
11. Enter the server address in dotted decimal notation or a host name.  
Scanning_ 4  
       
port.  
Using Samsung Scan and Fax Manager  
-Auto detection on the network: Automatically detects your machine.  
If you have installed the printer driver, the Samsung Scan and Fax Manager  
program is installed too. Start Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program to  
find out about this program information and the installed scan driver's  
condition. Through this program, you can change scan settings and add or  
delete the folders where scanned documents are saved in your computer.  
-IP or Host name: Enter in your machine’s IP address or host name to  
detect your machine.  
Scan Assistant  
You can scan by pressing Samsung Scan and Fax Manager > Quick  
The Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program can only be used in  
the Window and Macintosh system. If you use the Macintosh, See  
Scan.  
The Scan Assistant window allows you to adjust scan settings and start the  
scanning process.  
Favorites: Allows you to save the current preferences settings for  
future use. When you save Favorites, all current scan settings are  
saved. To use a saved setting, select it from the Favorites drop down  
list. The machine is now set to scan according to the setting you  
selected. To delete saved setting, select it from the Favorites drop  
down list and click Delete. To set a favorite as startup, select the favorite  
you want to set as startup, then click the Set as default button.  
1. From the Start menu, click Control Panel > Samsung Scan and Fax  
Manager.  
You can open Samsung Scan and Fax Manager by right clicking  
the Smart Panel icon in the Windows task bar and selecting Scan  
Manager.  
2. Select the appropriate machine from the Samsung Scan and Fax  
Scan sttings: The following scan options are available:  
Manager window.  
-Image Type: Allows you to chose the proper color settings for image  
3. Press Properties.  
4. The Set Scan Button tab allows you to change the saving destination  
scanning.  
-Resolution: Allows you to choose the image resolution.  
and scan settings, add or delete application program, and format files.  
-Document Size: Allows you to choose the proper size of the scanned  
You can change the scanning machine by using the Change Port tab.  
(Local or Network)  
image.  
-Document Source: Allows you to choose the device (document  
5. When setting is done, press OK.  
feeder or scan glass) you want to scan with.  
-Prompt for additional pages: If this check box is checked, you can  
scan pages continuously. This option is useful when you scan  
multipage documents and/or when Document Source is set to  
Flatbed (platen glass). In this case a sequence of scanned images is  
processed as a single document  
-Pages to Scan: Allows you to specify how many pages are to be  
scanned. This option is available when Document Source is set to  
ADF(Document feeder).  
Set Scan Button tab  
Scan Destination  
Available Destination List: Shows the list of applications currently  
linked to scanned images in the PC’s registry. Select the program  
you want to use and click the right arrow and add to Front Panel  
Destination List.  
Front Panel Destination List: Shows the list of applications to open  
Preference: The following scan options are available:  
scanned images.  
Add Application: Allows you to add an application you want to use to  
-Auto-crop image after preview: If this option is checked, the  
scanning area will be automatically adjusted to the image size.  
the Available Destination List.  
-Preview on program start: If this option is checked, the scanning  
Remove Application: Allows you to remove an item added by the  
user from the Available Destination List.  
area will be selected automatically as shown in the preview.  
File Format: Allows you to select the format of scanned data to be  
-Blank page detection: This operation automatically detects whether  
saved. You can choose among BMP, JPEG, PDF and TIFF.  
the scanned image is blank or not.  
-Delete page: Blank pages will be deleted at the end of the  
Scan Property  
Computer ID: Shows the ID of your computer.  
Save Location: Allows you to choose the location of the default saving  
scanning process.  
-Separate files: Blank page will work as a scan job separator. That  
is, when multiple pages are scanned at once a blank page will  
divide scanned image sequence into parts. Each part will be  
treated as a separate document (group).  
folder.  
Resolution: Allows you to choose the scan resolution.  
Scan Color: Allows you to choose the scan color.  
Scan Size: Allows you to choose the scan size.  
ADF Duplex: Automatically scans both sides. If your model does not  
support this option, it will be grayed out.  
Show Preview: Checking this box allows you to preview applied scan  
-Start from scanner: If this option is checked, scanning process is  
managed using scanner touch screen rather than from the computer.  
The option is not available for some scanner models.  
Advanced: In the Advanced mode, additional options such as Image  
Adjustment, Image Enhancement, and Additional Settings are  
available.  
-Image Adjustment: Allows you to perform some transformations of  
the scanned image. These transformations include automatic  
adjustment of image size, straightening and rotation.  
options. You can modify the options before scanning.  
Default: Allows you to go back to default options.  
Change Port tab  
-Image Enhancement: Allows you to remove various defects of the  
image and improve its quality.  
-Additional settings: Allows special processing of scanned images.  
Local Scanner: Select when your machine is connected via USB or  
LPT port.  
Network Scanner: Select when your machine is connected via network  
These transformations include stitching several partial image scans  
Scanning_ 5  
 
into a single image, processing of scanned books and watermark  
stamping.  
1. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
3. Press Duplex on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want is highlighted.  
Off: Scans in normal mode.  
Click the Help button from the lower-left corner of the window and  
click on any option you want to know about. Then a pop up window  
appears with information about that option's feature which is provided  
from the Scan Assistant.  
Changing the scan feature settings  
2 Side: Scans on both sides of the original.  
2->1Side ROT2: Scans on both sides of the original and prints each  
one on a separate sheet, but the information on the back side of the  
printout is rotated 180°.  
Your machine provides you with the following setting options to allow you to  
customize your scan jobs. The settings you change will be maintained for a  
certain time, but after that period, the options will be reset to default values.  
5. Press OK to save your selection.  
Scan Size: Sets the image size.  
Original Type: Sets the original documents’s type.  
Resolution: Sets the image resolution.  
Scan Color: Sets the color mode.  
Scan Format: Sets the file format in which the image is to be saved. If  
you select TIFF or PDF, you can select to scan multiple pages.  
Depending on the selected scan type, this option may not appear.  
Scanning with TWAIN-enabled software  
If you want to scan documents using other software, you will need to use  
TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe Photoshop.  
Follow the steps below to scan with TWAIN-compliant software:  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
To customize the settings before starting a scan job:  
on.  
1. Press (Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan Feature and press OK.  
3. Open an application, such as Adobe Photoshop.  
4. Open the TWAIN window and set the scan options.  
5. Scan and save your scanned image.  
4. Press the up/down until the scan type you want is highlighted and press  
OK.  
5. Press the up/down until the scan setting option you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the desired status highlights and press  
Scanning using the WIA driver  
OK.  
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to set other setting options.  
8. When you have finished, press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Your machine also supports the Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) driver for  
scanning images. WIA is one of the standard components provided by  
Microsoft Windows XP and works with digital cameras and scanners. Unlike  
the TWAIN driver, the WIA driver allows you to scan and easily adjust  
images without using additional software.  
Changing the default scan settings  
To avoid having to change the scan settings for each job, you can set up  
default scan settings for each scan type.  
The WIA driver works only on Windows XP/Vista/7 with a USB port.  
Windows XP  
1. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan Setup and press OK.  
4. Press OK when Change Default highlights .  
on.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass  
5. Press the up/down until the scan type you want is highlighted and press  
3. From the Start menu, select Control Panel, > Scanners and Cameras.  
4. Double click your scanner driver icon. The Scanner and Camera  
Wizard appears.  
5. Click Next.  
6. Set the option in Choose scanning preferences window and click  
OK.  
6. Press the up/down until the scan setting option you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow until the desired status highlights and press  
OK.  
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 to set other setting options.  
9. When you have finished, press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Preview to see how your options affect the picture.  
7. Click Next.  
8. Enter a picture name, and select a file format and destination to save the  
picture.  
Scan on both sides of paper  
9. Your picture has been successfully copied to your computer. Choose  
one of the options on screen.  
10. Click Next.  
This is available only when you load originals into the document  
feeder.  
11. Click Finish.  
By using the Duplex button on your machine, you can set the machine to  
scan on both sides of paper.  
Scanning_ 6  
           
Photoshop.  
Windows Vista  
Scan process differ according to TWAIN-compliant software. Please  
refer to the user’s guide of the software.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
on.  
If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to  
the latest version. Image Capture operates properly in Mac OS X  
10.3.9 or higher and Mac OS X 10.4.7 or higher.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass  
3. From the Start menu select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Scanners and Cameras.  
4. Double click Scan a document or picture. Windows Fax and Scan  
Scanning with network  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
on.  
application appears.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
You can click on View scanners and cameras to view scanners,  
If there is no Scan a document or picture, open the MS paint  
program and from the File click From Scanner or Camera... .  
5. Click New Scan. Scan driver appears.  
6. Choose your scanning preferences and click Preview to see your  
preferences affect the picture.  
7. Click Scan.  
original face down on the scanner glass  
3. Start Applications and click Image Capture.  
4. For Mac OS X 10.4 ~ 10.5  
Click Devices and click Browse Devices.  
For Mac OS X 10.6  
Select your device below SHARED. Skip to step 7.  
5. For Mac OS X 10.4:  
If you want to cancel the scan job, press the Cancel button on the  
Scanner and Camera Wizard.  
Select your machine in Twain devices option. Make sure that Use  
TWAIN software checkbox is checked, and click Connect.  
If a warning message appears, click Change Port.. to select port.  
If TWAIN UI appears, from the Preference tab, click Change Port.. to  
Windows 7  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
on.  
select port.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
Refer to Scan Manager for Change port.. use (See "Setting  
original face down on the scanner glass  
3. From the Start menu select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Devices and Printers.  
4. Click right button of mouse on device driver icon in Printers and Faxes  
> Start Scan. New Scan application appears.  
5. Choose your scanning preferences and click Preview to see your  
preferences affect the picture.  
6. Click Scan.  
For Mac OS X 10.5:  
Make sure that Connected checkbox is checked beside your machine in  
Bonjour Devices.  
If you want to scan using TWAIN, refer to the Mac OS X 10.4 steps  
above.  
6. Set the scan options on this program.  
7. Scan and save your scanned image.  
For more information about using Image Capture,refer to the Image  
Capture’s help.  
Use TWAIN-compliant software to apply more scan options.  
You can also scan using TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe  
Photoshop.  
Macintosh scanning  
You can scan documents using Image Capture program. Macintosh OS  
offers Image Capture program.  
Scan process differ according to TWAIN-compliant software. Please  
refer to the user’s guide of the software.  
If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to  
the latest version. Image Capture operates properly Mac OS X  
10.4.7 or higher.  
Scanning with USB  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered  
on.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass  
Setting scan information in Scan Manager  
To find out about Scan Manager program information, to check the  
installed scan driver's condition, to change scan settings. and to add or  
delete the folders where scanned documents to computer are saved in  
Scan Manager program, follow these instructions:  
3. Start Applications and click Image Capture.  
If No Image Capture device connected message appears,  
disconnect the USB cable and reconnect it. If the problem  
continues, refer to the Image Capture’s help.  
1.From the Smart Panel menu on Status bar, click Scan Manager.  
2.Select the appropriate machine from the Scan Manager.  
3. Press Properties.  
4. Set the scan options on this program.  
5. Scan and save your scanned image.  
For more information about using Image Capture, refer to the Image  
Capture’s help.  
Use TWAIN-compliant software to apply more scan options.  
4.Use Set Scan Button to change the file destination or scan settings,  
to add or delete application programs, and to format files. You can  
change the scanning machine by using Change port. (Local or  
Network)  
You can also scan using TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe  
Scanning_ 7  
   
5.When done, press OK.  
Preview Pane.  
Linux scanning  
You can scan a document using the Unified Driver Configurator window.  
Scanning  
1. Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator on your desktop.  
2. Click the  
button to switch to Scanners Configuration.  
3. Select the scanner on the list.  
7. Drag the pointer to set the image area to be scanned in the Preview  
Pane.  
8. Change the scan options in the Image Quality and Scan Area sections.  
Image Quality: This option allows you to select the color composition  
and the scan resolution for the image.  
Scan Area: This option allows you to select the page size. The  
Advanced button enables you to set the page size manually.  
If you want to use one of the preset scan option settings, select the  
option from the Job Type drop-down list (See "Adding Job Type  
If you use only one machine device and it is connected to the computer  
and turned on, your scanner appears on the list and is automatically  
selected.  
If you have two or more scanners connected to your computer, you can  
select any scanner to work at any time. For example, while acquisition is  
in progress on the first scanner, you may select the second scanner, set  
the device options and start the image acquisition simultaneously.  
Click Default to restore the default setting for the scan options.  
9. When you have finished, click Scan to start scanning.  
The status bar appears on the bottom left of the window to show you the  
progress of the scan. To cancel scanning, click Cancel.  
10. The scanned image appears.  
4. Click Properties.  
If you want to edit the scanned image, use the toolbar (See "Using the  
5. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the platen glass  
11. When you are finished, click Save on the toolbar.  
12. Select the file directory where you want to save the image and enter the  
file name.  
13. Click Save.  
6. From the Scanner Properties window, click Preview.  
The document is scanned and the image preview appears in the  
Adding Job Type Settings  
You can save your scan option settings for later use.  
To save a new Job Type setting:  
1.Change the options from the Scanner Properties window.  
2.Click Save As.  
3.Enter the name for your setting.  
4.Click OK.  
Your setting is added to the Saved Settings drop-down list.  
To save a Job Type setting for the next scan job:  
1.Select the setting you want to use from the Job Type drop-down list.  
2.The next time you open the Scanner Properties window, the saved  
setting is automatically selected for the scan job.  
Scanning_ 8  
   
To delete a Job Type setting  
1.Select the setting you want to delete from the Job Type drop-down  
Tools  
Name  
Save  
Function  
list.  
Saves the image.  
2.Click Delete.  
The setting is deleted from the list.  
Undo  
Redo  
Cancels your last action.  
Using the Image Manager  
The Image Manager application provides you with menu commands and  
tools to edit your scanned image.  
Restores the action you canceled.  
Scroll  
Crop  
Allows you to scroll through the image.  
Crops the selected image area.  
Zoom Out  
Zoom In  
Zooms the image out.  
Zooms the image in.  
Scale  
Allows you to scale the image size; you can  
enter the size manually, or set the rate to scale  
proportionally, vertically, or horizontally.  
Rotate  
Flip  
Allows you to rotate the image; you can select  
the number of degrees from the drop-down list.  
Use the following tools to edit the image:  
Allows you to flip the image vertically or  
horizontally.  
Brightness Allows you to adjust the brightness or contrast  
of the image, or to invert the image.  
Properties  
Shows the properties of the image.  
For further details about the Image Manager application, refer to the on  
screen help.  
Scanning_ 9  
 
1.  
faxing  
This chapter gives you information about using the fax feature in your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
5. Enter the recipients’ numbers and select the option.  
You cannot use this machine as a fax through the internet phone line.  
For more information ask your internet service provider.  
We recommend using traditional analog phone services (PSTN:  
public switched telephone network) when connecting telephone  
lines to use the Fax. If you use other Internet services (DSL, ISDN,  
VolP), you can improve the connection quality by using the  
Micro-filter. The Micro-filter eliminates unnecessary noise signals  
and improves connection quality or Internet quality. Since the DSL  
Micro-filter is not provided with the machine, contact your Internet  
Service provider for use on DSL Micro-filter.  
If you want to use a cover page, check Use cover page.  
Check Notify me on delivery, when the fax delivered to the recipients  
successfully.  
1 Line port  
2 Micro filter  
6. Click Send.  
3 DSL modem / Telephone line  
For more information about Samsung Network PC Fax, click Help.  
Checking a sent fax list  
You can check a sent fax list on your computer.  
Preparing to fax  
From the Start menu, click Programs or All Programs > Samsung  
Printers > Network PC Fax > Fax Journal. Then, the Fax Journal  
appears with the fax list you have sent.  
Before you send a fax, you need to connect the supplied line cord to the wall  
jack. Refer to the Quick Install Guide how to make a connection. The  
method of making a telephone connection varies from one country to  
another.  
Receiving a fax  
If you have installed the printer driver, the Samsung Scan & Fax Manager  
program is also installed. Start Samsung Scan & Fax Manager program to  
find out about this program information and the installed driver's condition.  
Through this program, you can change fax settings and add or delete the  
folders where faxed documents are saved in your computer.  
Using a fax in your computer  
You can send a fax from your computer without going to the machine.  
Sending a fax  
To send a fax from your computer, the Samsung Network PC Fax program  
must be installed. This program will be installed when you installed the  
printer driver.  
The Samsung Scan & Fax Manager program can only be used with  
the Windows and Macintosh systems. Check if the forwarding a fax to  
PC is set to On:  
a)Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
1. Open the document to be sent.  
2. Select Print from the File menu.  
b)Press Menu on the control panel.  
The Print window will be displayed. It may look slightly different  
depending on your application.  
c)Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature appears and  
press OK.  
3. Select Samsung Network PC Fax from the Print window  
d)Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward appears and press  
4. Click Print or OK.  
OK.  
Faxing_ 1  
   
6. Enter your name or the company name using the number keypad. You  
can enter alphanumeric characters using the number keypad, and  
include special symbols by pressing the 1 button. For details on how to  
enter alphanumeric characters, see "Entering characters using the  
e)Press the the up/down arrow to highlight PC: appears and press  
OK.  
1. Open the Samsung Scan & Fax Manager.  
For Windows, from the Start menu, click All programs > Samsung  
Printers > Samsung Scan & Fax Manager > Samsung Scan &  
Fax Manager.  
7. Press OK to save the ID.  
8. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Fax No. and press OK.  
9. Enter your fax number using the number keypad and press OK.  
10. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Or you can open this program by right clicking the Smart Panel icon  
in the Windows task bar and selecting the Samsung Scan & Fax  
Manager.  
For Macintosh, from the Smart Panel menu on status bar, click  
Samsung Scan & Fax Manager.  
2. Select the appropriate machine from the Samsung Scan & Fax  
Sending a fax  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
Manager.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
3. Click Properties.  
4. Use Set Fax Receiving to change the fax settings.  
5. When setting is done, press OK.  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
Set Fax Receiving tab  
Enable Fax Receiving: You can select whether to use or not.  
File Format: You can convert the received faxes to PDF or TIFF.  
Save Location: Selects location to save the converted faxes.  
Prefix: Selects file or folder scheme as prefix.  
Notify me when fax received: Shows popup window to notify  
receiving a fax.  
Print received fax: After receiving the fax, set prints information for  
the received fax.  
Change Port tab  
Local Scanner: Select when your machine is connected via USB or  
3. Adjust the resolution and the darkness to suit your fax needs (See  
4. Enter the receiving fax machine’s number.  
LPT port.  
Network Scanner: Select when your machine is connected via  
network port.  
You can use speed dial numbers, or group dial numbers. For details  
about storing and searching for a number, see "Setting up address  
-Auto detection on the network: Automatically detects your  
machine.  
-IP or Host name: Enter in your machine’s IP address or host name  
5. Press Start on the control panel. The machine starts to scan and send a  
to detect your machine.  
fax to destinations.  
If you want to send fax directly from your computer, use SmarThru  
When you want to cancel a fax job, press Stop/Clear before the  
machine start transmission.  
If you used the scanner glass, the machine shows the message  
asking to place another page.  
Sending a fax  
This part explains how to send a fax and the special methods of  
transmission.  
When you place the originals, in the document feeder and/or on the  
platen glass one at a time (See "Loading originals" on page 1). If the  
originals are placed on both the document feeder and the scanner  
glass, the machine will read the originals on the document feeder first,  
which has higher priority in scanning.  
While the machine is sending a fax, you can not send an email at the  
same time.  
Sending a fax manually  
This method is sending a fax using On Hook Dial on the control panel.  
Setting the fax header  
In some countries, you are required by law to indicate your fax number on  
any fax you send.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
3. Adjust the resolution and the darkness to suit your fax needs (See  
4. Press On Hook Dial on the control panel.  
5. Enter a fax number using the number keypad on the control panel.  
6. Press Start when you hear a high-pitched fax signal from the remote fax  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine ID and press OK.  
machine.  
Faxing_ 2  
 
11. When you have finished entering fax numbers, press the left/right arrow  
When you want to cancel a fax job, press Stop/Clear at any time while  
sending.  
to select No when Another Page? appears.  
12. If an original is placed on the scanner glass, select Yes to add another  
pages. Load another original and press OK.  
When you have finished, select No when Another Page? appears.  
The machine begins sending the fax to the numbers you entered in the  
order in which you entered them.  
Confirming a transmission  
When the last page of your original has been sent successfully, the machine  
beeps and returns to ready mode.  
When something goes wrong while sending your fax, an error message  
appears on the display. For a list of error messages and their meanings, see  
"Understanding display messages" on page 8. If you receive an error  
message, press Stop/Clear to clear the message and try to send the fax  
again.  
Delaying a fax transmission  
You can set your machine to send a fax at a later time when you will not be  
present. You cannot send a color fax using this feature.  
You can set your machine to print a confirmation report automatically each  
time sending a fax is completed. For further details, see "Printing sent fax  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
3. Adjust the resolution and the darkness to suit your fax needs (See  
4. Press Menu on the control panel.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Delay Send and press OK.  
7. Enter the number of the receiving fax machine and press OK.  
Automatic redialing  
When the number you have dialed is busy or there is no answer when you  
send a fax, the machine automatically redials the number. The redial time  
depends on the country's factory default setting. To change the time interval  
between redials and the number of redial attempts (See "Changing the fax  
When the display shows Retry Redial?, press OK to redial the number  
You can press speed dial numbers or select group dial number using  
Address book button. For details, see "Setting up address book" on  
page 7.  
without waiting. To cancel the automatic redialing, press Stop/Clear.  
Redialing the last number  
To redial the number you called last:  
1. Press Redial/Pause on the control panel.  
8. The display asks you to enter another fax number to send the document.  
9. To enter more fax numbers, press OK when Yes highlights and repeat  
steps 7. You can add up to 10 destinations.  
2. When an original is loaded in the document feeder, the machine  
Once you entered a group dial number, you cannot enter another  
group dial numbers anymore.  
automatically begins to send.  
If an original is placed on the scanner glass, select Yes to add another  
page. Load another original and press OK. When you have finished,  
select No when Another Page? appears.  
10. When you have finished entering fax numbers, press the left/right arrow  
to select No when Another Page? appears and press OK.  
11. Enter the job name you want and press OK.  
Sending a fax to multiple destinations  
For details on how to enter alphanumeric characters, see "Entering  
If you do not want to assign a name, skip this step.  
You can use the Multiple Send feature, which allows you to send a fax to  
multiple locations. Originals are automatically stored in memory and sent to  
a remote station. After transmission, the originals are automatically erased  
from memory. You cannot send a color fax using this feature.  
12. Enter the time using the number keypad and press OK.  
If you set a time earier than the current time, the fax will be sent at  
that time on the following day.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
3. Adjust the resolution and the darkness to suit your fax needs (See  
4. Press Menu on the control panel.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Multi Send and press OK.  
7. Enter the number of the first receiving fax machine and press OK.  
The original is scanned into memory before transmission.  
13. If an original is placed on the scanner glass, select Yes to add another  
pages. Load another original and press OK.  
When you have finished, select No when Another Page? appears.  
The machine returns to ready mode. The display reminds you that you  
are in ready mode and that a delayed fax is set.  
Adding documents to a reserved delay fax job  
You can press speed dial numbers or select group dial number using  
Address book button. For details, see "Setting up address book" on  
page 7.  
You can add additional documents to the delayed fax job which is saved  
in memory.  
1.Load the originals to be added and adjust document settings.  
2.Press Menu on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Add Pages and press OK.  
8. Enter the second fax number and press OK.  
The display asks you to enter another fax number to send the document.  
9. To enter more fax numbers, press OK when Yes highlights and repeat  
steps 7 and 8. You can add up to 10 destinations.  
10. Press OK to start storing the scanned original data into memory.  
5.Press the up/down arrow until the fax job you want appears and press  
OK.  
Once you entered a group dial number, you cannot enter another  
group dial numbers anymore.  
When you have finished, select No when Another Page? appears.  
The machine scans the original into memory.  
Faxing_ 3  
6.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Receiving a fax  
Canceling a reserved delay fax job  
You can cancel the delayed fax job which is saved in memory.  
This part explains how to receive a fax, and the special receiving methods  
available.  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
Changing the receive modes  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Cancel Job and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow until the fax job you want appears and press  
Your machine is preset to Copy mode at the factory; however you can  
change the default so fax is priority (See "Changing the default mode" on  
page 2). When you receive a fax, the machine answers the call on a  
specified number of rings and automatically receives the fax. But if you want  
to change the Fax mode to another mode, follow the steps below:  
OK.  
5.Press OK when Yes highlights.  
The selected fax is deleted from memory.  
6.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Sending a priority fax  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Receiving and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Receive Mode and press OK.  
This function is used when a high priority fax need to be sent ahead of  
reserved operations. The original is scanned into memory and immediately  
transmitted when the current operation is finished. In addition, priority  
transmission will interrupt a sending to multiple destinations between  
stations (example, when the transmission to station A ends, before  
transmission to station B begins) or between redial attempts.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the fax reception mode you want  
highlights.  
Fax: Answers an incoming fax call and immediately goes into the fax  
reception mode.  
Tel: Receives a fax by pressing On Hook Dial and then Start.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
3. Adjust the resolution and the darkness to suit your fax needs (See  
4. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Ans/Fax: Is for when an answering machine attached to your machine.  
Your machine answers an incoming call, and the caller can leave a  
message on the answering machine. If the fax machine senses a fax  
tone on the line, the machine automatically switches to Fax mode to  
receive the fax.  
DRPD: you can receive a call using the Distinctive Ring Pattern  
Detection (DRPD) feature. Distinctive Ring is a telephone company  
service which enables an user to use a single telephone line to  
answer several different telephone numbers. For further details, see  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Priority Send and press OK.  
7. Enter the number of the receiving fax machine and press OK.  
You can press speed dial numbers or select group dial number using  
Address book button. For details, see "Setting up address book" on  
page 7.  
This setting may not be available depending on your country.  
8. Enter the job name you want and press OK.  
7. Press OK to save your selection.  
The original is scanned into memory before transmission.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
9. If an original is placed on the scanner glass, select Yes to add another  
To use the Ans/Fax mode, attach an answering machine to the  
pages. Load another original and press OK.  
When you have finished, select No when Another Page? appears.  
The machine starts to scan and send a fax to destinations.  
EXT socket on the back of your machine.  
If you do not want other people to view your received documents,  
you can use secure receiving mode. In this mode, all of the  
received faxes are stored in memory. For further details, see  
Sending faxes on both sides of paper  
This is available only when you load originals into the document  
feeder.  
Receiving manually in Tel mode  
You can receive a fax call by pressing On Hook Dial and then pressing  
Start when you hear a fax tone ; however you can change the default so fax  
is priority (See "Changing the default mode" on page 2). The machine  
begins receiving the fax.  
You can set the machine to send faxes on both sides of paper.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Place originals, face up, in the document feeder. Or you can use the  
scanner glass with a single original document face down and closed the  
scanner lid.  
To change the number of rings, see "Changing the fax setup options" on  
page 1.  
3. Press Duplex on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want highlights.  
Off: Send faxes in normal mode.  
Receiving automatically in Answering Machine/Fax  
mode  
To use this mode, you must attach an answering machine to the EXT socket  
on the back of your machine (See "Rear view" on page 2).  
2 Side: Send faxes on both sides of the original.  
If the caller leaves a message, the answering machine stores the message  
as it would normally. If your machine detects a fax tone on the line, it  
automatically starts to receive the fax.  
2->1Side ROT2: Send faxes on both sides of the original and prints  
each one on a separate sheet, but the information on the back side  
of the printout is rotated 180°.  
5. Press OK to save your selection.  
Faxing_ 4  
   
If you have set your machine to this mode and your answering  
machine is switched off, or no answering machine is connected to  
EXT socket, your machine automatically goes into Fax mode after  
a predefined number of rings.  
If your answering machine has a user-selectable ring counter, set the  
machine to answer incoming calls within 1 ring.  
If you are in Tel mode when the answering machine is connected to  
your machine, you must switch off the answering machine.  
Otherwise, the outgoing message from the answering machine will  
interrupt your phone conversation.  
DRPD must be set up again if you re-assign your fax number, or  
connect the machine to another telephone line.  
After DRPD has been set up, call your fax number again to verify  
that the machine answers with a fax tone. Then have a call  
placed to a different number assigned to that same line to be  
sure the call is forwarded to the extension telephone or  
answering machine plugged into the EXT socket.  
Receiving in secure receiving mode  
You may need to prevent your received faxes from being accessed by  
unauthorized people. You can turn on secure receiving mode to restrict  
printing of received faxes when the machine is unattended. In secure  
receiving mode, all incoming faxes go into memory. When the mode is  
deactivated, any stored faxes are printed.  
Receiving faxes manually using an extension  
telephone  
This feature works best when you are using an extension telephone  
connected to the EXT socket on the back of your machine. You can receive  
a fax from someone you are talking to on the extension telephone, without  
going to the fax machine.  
Activating secure receiving mode  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
When you receive a call on the extension phone and hear fax tones, press  
the keys *9* on the extension phone. The machine receives the fax.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Secure Receive and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
6. Enter a four-digit password you want to use and press OK.  
Press the buttons slowly in sequence. If you still hear the fax tone from the  
remote machine, try pressing *9* once again.  
*9* is the remote receive code preset at the factory. The first and the last  
asterisks are fixed, but you can change the middle number to whatever you  
wish. For details about changing the code, see "Changing the fax setup  
You can activate secure receiving mode without setting a  
password, but cannot protect your faxes.  
Receiving faxes using DRPD mode  
7. Re-enter the password to confirm it and press OK.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
When a fax is received in secure receiving mode, your machine stores it in  
memory and shows Secure Receive to let you know that there is a fax  
received.  
Distinctive Ring is a telephone company service which enables an user to  
use a single telephone line to answer several different telephone numbers.  
The particular number someone uses to call you is identified by different  
ringing patterns, which consist of various combinations of long and short  
ringing sounds. This feature is often used by answering services who  
answer telephones for many different clients and need to know which  
number someone is calling in on to properly answer the phone.  
Printing received faxes  
1.Access the Secure Receive menu by following steps 1 through 4 in  
Using the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) feature, your fax  
machine can learn the ring pattern you designate to be answered. Unless  
you change it, this ringing pattern will continue to be recognized and  
answered as a fax call, and all other ringing patterns will be forwarded to the  
extension telephone or answering machine plugged into the EXT socket.  
You can easily suspend or change DRPD at any time.  
Before using the DRPD option, Distinctive Ring service must be installed on  
your telephone line by the telephone company. To set up DRPD, you will  
need another telephone line at your location, or someone available to dial  
your fax number from outside.  
“Activating secure receiving mode.”  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Print and press OK.  
3.Enter the four-digit password and press OK.  
The machine prints all of the faxes stored in memory.  
Deactivating secure receiving mode  
1.Access the Secure Receive menu by following steps 1 through 4 in  
“Activating secure receiving mode.”  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Off and press OK.  
3.Enter the four-digit password and press OK.  
To set up the DRPD mode:  
The mode is deactivated and the machine prints all faxes stored in  
memory.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
4.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Receiving and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight DRPD Mode and press OK.  
Waiting Ring appears on the display.  
Printing received faxes on both sides of the paper  
Set this duplex feature to save paper. When the machine prints the received  
fax data, it prints them on both sides of the paper.  
6. Call your fax number from another telephone. It is not necessary to  
place the call from a fax machine.  
7. When your machine begins to ring, do not answer the call. The machine  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Receiving and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Duplex Print and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the binding option you want highlights.  
requires several rings to learn the pattern.  
When the machine completes learning, the display shows Completed  
DRPD Setup. If the DRPD setup fails, Error DRPD Ring appears.  
Press OK when DRPD appears and start over from step 6.  
Faxing_ 5  
       
Off: Prints in Normal mode.  
Long Edge: Prints pages to be read like a book.  
mode  
recommended for:  
Super Fine  
Originals containing extremely fine detail. Super Fine  
mode is enabled only if the machine with which you are  
communicating also supports the Super Fine resolution.  
For memory transmission, Super Fine mode is  
not available. The resolution setting is  
automatically changed to Fine  
Short Edge: Prints pages to be read by flipping like a note pad.  
2
When your machine is set to Super Fine  
resolution and the fax machine with which you  
are communicating does not support Super  
Fine resolution, the machine transmits using  
the highest resolution mode supported by the  
other fax machine.  
3
5
Photo Fax  
Originals containing shades of gray or photographs.  
7. Press OK to save your selection.  
The resolution setting is applied to the current fax job. To change the  
default setting, see "Change default" on page 2.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Receiving faxes in memory  
Darkness  
Since your machine is a multi-tasking device, it can receive faxes while you  
are making copies or printing. If you receive a fax while you are copying or  
printing, your machine stores incoming faxes in its memory. Then, as soon  
as you finish copying or printing, the machine automatically prints the fax.  
You can select the degree of darkness of the original document.  
1. Press (Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Darkness and press OK.  
Adjusting the document settings  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the option you want highlights and press  
Before starting a fax, change the following settings according to your  
original’s status to get the best quality.  
OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Resolution  
The darkness setting is applied to the current fax job. To change the  
default setting, see "Change default" on page 2.  
The default document settings procedure good results when using typical  
text-based originals. However, if you send originals that are of poor quality,  
or contain photographs, you can adjust the resolution to produce a higher  
quality fax.  
Scan size  
You can choose the size to be scanned.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
The scan size options may vary between document feeder or scanner  
glass.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Resolution and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the option you want is highlighted and  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan Size and press OK.  
press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the scan size you want highlights and  
Recommended resolution settings for different original document types are  
described in the table below:  
press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
mode  
recommended for:  
Forwarding a fax to another destination  
Standard  
Fine  
Originals with normal sized characters.  
Originals containing small characters or thin lines or  
originals printed using a dot-matrix printer.  
You can set the machine to forward the received or sent fax to other  
destination by a fax, an email or a server. If you are out of office but have to  
receive the fax, this feature may be useful.  
When you forward a fax by an email, you must first set the mail server  
and IP address in SyncThru™ Web Service (See "Using SyncThru™  
Forwarding a sent fax to another destination  
You can set the machine to forward every fax you sent to another  
destination.  
Faxing_ 6  
   
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Email and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Receive Forward and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
To set the machine to print out a fax when fax forwarding has been  
completed, select Forward & Print.  
8. Enter your email address and press OK.  
9. Enter the email address to which faxes are to be sent and press OK.  
10. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Send Forward and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
8. Enter the number of the fax machine to which faxes are to be sent and  
press OK.  
9. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Subsequent received faxes will be forwarded to the specified email  
addresses.  
Subsequent sent faxes will be forwarded to the specified fax machine.  
Forwarding a received fax to another destination  
With this feature, you can forward every fax you received to another  
destination by faxing. When the machine receives a fax, a fax is stored in  
the memory then, the machine sends it to the destination you have set.  
Forwarding a sent fax to other destination by a  
server  
When you forward a fax to FTP or SMB server, you must first set the  
server in SyncThru™ Web Service (See "Setting up an FTP server"  
a fax to a total of five destinations via the SMB or FTP.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Receive Forward and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
To set the machine to print out a fax when fax forwarding has been  
completed, select Forward & Print.  
8. Enter the number of the fax machine to which faxes are to be sent and  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Server and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Send Forward and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
press OK.  
Subsequent sent faxes will be forwarded to the specified server.  
9. Enter the starting time using up/down, left/right arrow or numeric keypad  
and press OK.  
Forwarding a received fax to other destination by  
server  
10. Enter the ending time using up/down, left/right arrow or numeric keypad  
and press OK.  
11. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
When you forward a fax to FTP or SMB server, you must first set the  
server in SyncThru™ Web Service (See "Setting up an FTP server"  
a fax to a total of five destinations via the SMB or FTP.  
Subsequent received faxes will be forwarded to the specified fax  
machine.  
Forwarding a sent fax to other destination by an  
email  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Server and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Receive Forward and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
To set the machine to print out a fax when fax forwarding has been  
completed, select Forward & Print.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Forward and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Email and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Send Forward and press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
8. Enter your email address and press OK.  
9. Enter the email address to which faxes are to be sent and press OK.  
10. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Subsequent received faxes will be forwarded to the specified server.  
Subsequent sent faxes will be forwarded to the specified email address.  
Setting up address book  
Forwarding a received fax to other destination by an  
email  
You can set up Address Book with the fax numbers you use most  
frequently. Your machine provides you with the following features for setting  
up Address Book:  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
Before beginning to store fax numbers, make sure that your machine  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
Faxing_ 7  
   
is in Fax mode.  
If an entry is already stored in the number you choose, the display  
shows the message to allow you to change it.  
Speed dial numbers  
You can store up to 240 frequently-used fax numbers in speed dial  
numbers.  
6.Enter the name you want and press OK.  
For details on how to enter alphanumeric characters, see ""Entering  
7.Enter the first few letters of the speed dial’s name you want.  
8.Press the up/down arrow until the name and number you want  
Registering a speed dial number  
highlights and press OK.  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
9.Press OK when Yes highlights when Another Page? appears.  
Repeat step 7 to include other speed dial numbers into the group.  
10.When you have finished, press the left/right arrow to select No when  
Another Page? appears and press OK.  
11.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight New & Edit and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Speed Dial and press OK.  
5.Enter a speed dial number between 1 and 240 and press OK.  
If an entry is already stored in the number you choose, the display  
shows the message to allow you to change it. To start over with  
another speed dial number, press Back.  
Editing a group dial number  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
6.Enter the name you want and press OK.  
For details on how to enter alphanumeric characters, see ""Entering  
7.Enter the fax number you want and press OK.  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight New & Edit and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Group Dial and press OK.  
5.Enter the group dial number you want to edit and press OK.  
6.Enter the name you want to edit and press OK.  
8.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Editing speed dial numbers  
7.Enter the first few letters of the speed dial’s name you want to add or  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
delete.  
8.Press the up/down arrow until the name and number you want  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
highlights and press OK.  
If you entered a new speed dial number, Add? appears.  
If you enter a speed dial number stored in the group, Delete?  
appears.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight New & Edit and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Speed Dial and press OK.  
5.Enter the speed dial number you want to edit and press OK.  
6.Change the name and press OK.  
7.Change the fax number and press OK.  
8.Change the name and press OK.  
9.Press OK to add or delete the number.  
10.Press OK when Yes highlights to add or delete more numbers and  
repeat steps 7 and 8.  
11.When you have finished, press the left/right arrow to select No at the  
9.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Another Number? and press OK.  
12.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Using speed dial numbers  
When you are prompted to enter a destination number while sending a  
fax, enter the speed dial number at which you stored the number you  
want.  
For a one-digit (0-9) speed dial number, press and hold the  
corresponding digit button on the number keypad.  
For a two- or three-digit speed dial number, press the first digit button(s)  
and then hold down the last digit button.  
Using group dial numbers  
To use a group dial entry, you need to search for and select it from  
memory.  
When you are prompted to enter a fax number while sending a fax,  
press Address Book. See below.  
You can also search through memory for an entry by pressing Address  
Searching address book for an entry  
There are two ways to search for a number in memory. You can either scan  
from A to Z sequentially, or you can search by entering the first letters of the  
name associated with the number.  
Group dial numbers  
If you frequently send the same document to several destinations, you can  
group these destinations and set them under a group dial number. You can  
then use a group dial number to send a document to all of the destinations  
within the group. You can set up to 200 (0 through 199) group dial numbers  
using the destination’s existing speed dial numbers.  
Searching sequentially through the memory  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Search & Dial and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Group Dial and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight All and press OK.  
Registering a group dial number  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
6.Press the up/down arrow until the name and number you want  
highlights. You can search upwards or downwards through the entire  
memory in alphabetical order.  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight New & Edit and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Group Dial and press OK.  
5.Enter a group dial number between 0 and 199 and press OK.  
Faxing_ 8  
 
Searching sequentially through the memory  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Search & Dial and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Group Dial and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Search ID and press OK.  
6.Enter the first few letters of the name you want.  
7.Press the up/down arrow until the group dial’s name and number you  
want highlights.  
Deleting a Address Book for entry  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Delete and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow until the deleting option you want is  
highlighted and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow until the searching method you want  
highlights and press OK.  
Select Search All to search for an entry by scanning through all  
entries in Address Book.  
Select Search ID to search for an entry by the first few letters of the  
name.  
6.Press the up/down arrow until the name you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
Or, enter the first letters. Press the up/down arrow until the name you  
want highlights and press OK.  
7.Press OK when Yes highlights to confirm the deletion.  
8.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Printing Address Book  
You can check your Address Book settings by printing a list.  
1.Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2.Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Print and press OK.  
The machine begins printing.  
Printing sent fax report automatically  
You can set the machine to print a report with detailed information about the  
previous 50 communication operations, including time and dates.  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Auto Report and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight On and press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Faxing_ 9  
   
1.  
using usb memory device  
This chapter explains how to use a USB memory device with your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
files stored in the USB memory device may be corrupted, or the  
machine may not automatically detect it. For details about these  
features, see device’s User’s Guide.  
About USB memory device  
USB memory devices are available with a variety of memory capacities to  
give you more room for storing documents, presentations, music and  
videos, high resolution photographs, or whatever other files you want to  
store or move.  
Scanning to an USB memory device  
You can do the following on your machine using an USB memory device:  
You can scan a document and save the scanned image onto an USB  
memory device. There are two ways of doing this: you can scan to the  
device using the default settings, or you can customize your own scan  
settings. When you scan a document, the machine uses the default settings  
such as the resolution. You can also customize your own scan setting.  
Scan documents and save them on an USB memory device.  
Print data stored on an USB memory device.  
Format the USB memory device.  
Your machine supports USB memory devices with FAT16/FAT32 and  
sector size of 512 bytes.  
If your USB memory device has certain features (example, security key,  
security partition, booting disk, password settings and so forth), do not use  
the USB memory device with your machine. The files stored in the USB  
memory device may be corrupted, or the machine may not automatically  
detect it. For details about these features, see device’s User’s Guide.  
Check your USB memory device’s file system from your dealer.  
You must use only an authorized USB memory device with an A plug type  
connector.  
Scanning  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
machine.  
2. Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
Use only an USB memory device with metal-shielded connector.  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
3. Press  
(Scan/Email) and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan To USB and press OK.  
Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your machine.  
Your machine begins scanning the original, and then asks if you want to  
scan another page.  
5. To scan another page, press the left/right arrow to highlight Yes and  
press OK. Load an original and press Start.  
Otherwise, press the left/right arrow to highlight No and press OK.  
6. After scanning is complete, you can remove the USB memory device  
from the machine.  
Customizing scan to USB  
You can specify image size, file format, or color mode for each scanning to  
USB job.  
1. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan Feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight USB Feature and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight the setting you want and press OK.  
You can set the following options:  
Do not remove the USB memory device while it is in use. The  
machine warranty does not cover damage caused by user’s  
misuse.  
If your USB memory device has certain features (example, security  
key, security partition, booting disk, password settings and so  
forth), do not use the USB memory device with your machine. The  
Scan Size: Sets the image size.  
Using USB memory device_ 1  
       
7. To print another document, press the left/right arrow to highlight Yes and  
The scan size options may vary between document feeder or  
scanner glass.  
press OK. Repeat from step 3.  
Otherwise, press the left/right arrow to highlight No and press OK.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Original Type: Sets the original document’s type.  
Resolution: Sets the image resolution.  
Scan Color: Sets the color mode. If you select Mono in this option,  
Backing up data  
you cannot select JPEG in Scan Format.  
Scan Format: Sets the file format in which the image is to be saved.  
When you select TIFF or PDF, you can select to scan multiple  
pages. If you select JPEG in this option, you cannot select Mono in  
Scan Color.  
Data in the machine’s memory can be accidentally erased due to power  
failure or storage failure. Backup helps you protect your Address Book  
entries and the system settings by storing them as backup files on a USB  
memory device.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the desired status is highlighted and press  
OK.  
Backing up data  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to set other setting options.  
8. When you have finished, press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
You can change the default scan settings. For details, see "Changing the  
machine.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Export Setting and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the option you want is highlighted.  
Address Book: Backs up all Address Book entries.  
Setup Data: Backs up all system settings.  
7. Press OK to begin backing up the data.  
The data is backed up to the USB memory.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Printing from a USB memory device  
You can directly print files stored on a USB memory device. You can print  
TIFF, BMP, JPEG and PRN files.  
If your USB memory device has certain features (example, security key,  
security partition, booting disk, password settings and so forth), do not use  
the USB memory device with your machine. The files stored in the USB  
memory device may be corrupted, or the machine may not automatically  
detect it. For details about these features, see device’s User’s Guide.  
Direct Print option supported file types:  
Restoring data  
1. Insert a USB memory device on which the backup data is stored in to the  
USB memory port.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Import Setting and press OK.  
PRN: Only files created by provided driver with your machine are  
compatible. PRN files can be created by selecting the Print to file check  
box when you print a document. The document will be saved as a PRN  
file, rather than printed on paper. Only PRN files created in this fashion  
can be printed directly from USB memory device (See "Printing to a file  
If you print PRN files created from other machine, the printout  
would be different .  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the data type you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
BMP: BMP Uncompressed  
TIFF: TIFF 6.0 Baseline  
JPEG: JPEG Baseline  
PDF: PDF 1.4 and below  
7. Press the up/down arrow until the file containing the data you want to  
restore highlights and press OK.  
8. To restore the backup file to the machine, press the left/right arrow to  
highlight Yes and press OK.  
9. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
To print a document from a USB memory device:  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
machine. If one has already been inserted, press Direct USB.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight USB Print and press OK.  
Managing USB memory  
You can delete image files stored on a USB memory device one by one or  
all at once by reformatting the device.  
Your machine automatically detects the device and reads data stored on  
it.  
3. Press the up/down arrow until the folder or file you want is highlighted  
After deleting files or reformatting a USB memory device, files cannot  
be restored. Therefore, confirm that you no longer need the data  
before deleting it.  
and press OK.  
If you see + in the front of a folder name, there are one or more files or  
folders in the selected folder.  
Deleting an image file  
4. If you selected a file, skip to the next step.  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
If you selected a folder, press the up/down arrow until the file you want is  
machine.  
highlighted and press OK.  
2. Press Direct USB on the control panel.  
5. Press the up/down arrow to select the number of copies to be printed or  
enter the number.  
6. Press OK or Start to start printing the selected file.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight File Manage and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Delete and press OK.  
After printing the file, the display asks if you want to print another job.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the folder or file you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
Using USB memory device_ 2  
     
If you see + in the front of a folder name, there are one or more  
files or folders in the selected folder.  
If you selected a file, the display shows the size of the file for about 2  
seconds. Go to the next step.  
If you selected a folder, press the up/down arrow until the file you want  
to delete highlights and press OK.  
6. To delete file, press the up/down arrow to highlight Yes and press OK.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Formatting a USB memory device  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
machine.  
2. Press Direct USB on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight File Manage and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Format and press OK.  
5. To format USB memory device, Press the up/down arrow to highlight  
Yes and press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Viewing the USB memory status  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
machine.  
2. Press Direct USB on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Check Space and press OK.  
The available memory space appears on the display.  
4. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Using USB memory device_ 3  
1.  
machine status and advanced feature  
This chapter explains how to browse the current status of your machine, and the method of setting for the advanced  
machine setup. Read this chapter carefully in order to use your machine's diverse features.  
This chapter includes:  
Some menus may not appear in the display depending on options or  
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.  
Option  
Description  
Send Report  
You can set your machine to print a confirmation  
report showing whether a transmission was  
successful, how many pages were sent, and  
more. The available options are On, Off, and  
On-Error, which prints only when a transmission  
is not successful.  
Fax setup  
Changing the fax setup options  
Your machine provides you with various user-selectable options for setting  
up the fax system. You can change the default settings for your preferences  
and needs.  
Image TCR  
This function allows users to know what fax  
messages have been sent by showing sent  
messages in the transmission report.  
The first page of the message is turned into an  
image file than is printed on the transmission  
report so the users can see what messages  
have been sent.  
To change the fax setup options:  
1. Press  
(Fax) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Fax Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the fax setup item you want is highlighted  
However, you can not use this function when  
sending fax without saving the data in the  
memory.  
and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the option you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
Dial Mode  
This setting may not be available depending on  
your country. If you cannot reach this option,  
your machine does not support this feature.  
You can set the dial mode for your machine to  
either tone dialing or pulse dialing. If you have a  
public telephone system or a private branch  
exchnage (PBX) system, you may need to select  
Pulse. Contact your local telephone company if  
you are not sure which dial mode to use.  
If you select Pulse, some phone system  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the desired status appears or enter the  
value for the option you have selected, and press OK.  
7. If necessary, repeat steps 4 through 6.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Sending  
Option  
Description  
features might not be available. It can also take  
longer to dial a fax or phone number.  
Redial Times  
You can specify the number of redial attempts. If  
you enter 0, the machine will not redial.  
Redial Term  
Prefix Dial  
Your machine can automatically redial a remote  
fax machine if it was busy. You can set an  
interval between attempts.  
Receiving  
Option  
Description  
You can set a prefix of up to five digits. This  
number dials before any automatic dial number  
is started. It is useful for accessing a PABX  
exchange.  
Receive Mode  
You can select the default fax receiving mode.  
For details on receiving faxes in each mode, see  
ECM Mode  
This mode helps with poor line quality and  
makes sure any faxes you send are sent  
smoothly to any other ECM-equipped fax  
machine. Sending a fax using ECM may take  
more time.  
Ring To Answer  
You can specify the number of times the  
machine rings before answering an incoming  
call.  
Machine status and advanced feature_ 1  
             
Option  
Description  
Option  
Description  
Stamp RCV Name  
This option allows the machine to automatically  
print the page number, and the date and time of  
reception at the bottom of each page of a  
received fax.  
Doc Box Saving  
This menu only appears when an optional hard  
disk drive (HDD) has been installed. With this  
feature set to On, allows you to store received  
faxes in the common box.  
Rcv Start Code  
Auto Reduction  
This code allows you to initiate fax reception  
from an extension phone plugged into the EXT  
socket on the back of the machine. If you pick up  
the extension phone and hear fax tones, enter  
the code. It is preset to *9* at the factory.  
Change default  
Option  
Description  
Resolution  
Changing the resolution setting affects the  
appearance of the received document.  
When receiving a fax containing pages as long  
as or longer than the paper loaded in the paper  
tray, the machine can reduce the size of the  
original to fit the size of the paper loaded in the  
machine.  
Turn on this feature if you want to automatically  
reduce an incoming page.  
With this feature set to Off, the machine cannot  
reduce the original to fit onto one page. The  
original will be divided and printed in actual size  
on two or more pages.  
Standard: Originals with normal sized  
characters.  
Fine: Originals containing small characters  
or thin lines or originals printed using a  
dot-matrix printer.  
Super Fine: Originals containing extremely  
fine detail. Super Fine mode is enabled only  
if the machine with which you are  
communicating also supports the Super  
Fine resolution.  
Discard Size  
When receiving a fax containing pages as long  
as or longer than the paper in your machine, you  
can set the machine to discard a specific length  
from the end of the received fax. The machine  
will print the received fax on one or more sheets  
of paper, minus the data that would have been  
on the specified discard segment.  
When the received fax contains pages larger  
than the paper in your machine, and Auto  
Reduction has been turned on, the machine will  
reduce the fax to fit on the existing paper, and  
nothing will be discarded.  
For memory transmission, Super Fine  
mode is not available. The  
resolution setting is automatically  
changed to Fine.  
When your machine is set to Super  
Fine resolution and the fax  
machine with which you are  
communicating does not support  
Super Fine resolution, the machine  
transmits using the highest  
resolution mode supported by the  
other fax machine.  
Junk Fax Setup  
This setting may not be available depending on  
your country. Using this feature, the system will  
not accept faxes sent from remote stations  
whose numbers are stored in the memory as  
junk fax numbers. This feature is useful for  
blocking any unwanted faxes.  
Photo Fax: Originals containing shades of  
gray or photographs.  
Darkness  
Scan Size  
You can select the default contrast mode to fax  
your originals lighter or darker.  
When you turn on this feature, you can access  
the following options to set junk fax numbers.  
Sets the image size.  
The scan size options may vary between  
document feeder or scanner glass.  
Add: Allows you to set up to 10 fax  
numbers.  
Delete: Allows you to delete the desired  
junk fax number. If you select Delete All,  
Allows you to delete all junk fax numbers.  
Auto Report  
You can set the machine to print a report with detailed information about the  
previous 50 communication operations, including time and dates.  
DRPD Mode  
Duplex Print  
This setting may not be available depending on  
your country. This mode enables a user to use a  
single telephone line to answer several different  
telephone numbers. In this menu, you can set  
the machine to recognize which ring patterns to  
answer. For details about this feature, see  
Copy setup  
Changing the copy setup options  
For copy output, you can set up several options in advance.  
Set this duplex feature to save paper. When the  
machine prints the received fax data, it prints  
them on both sides of the paper. For details  
about this feature, see "Printing received faxes  
1. Press  
(Copy) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Copy Setup and press OK.  
Machine status and advanced feature_ 2  
   
4. Press the up/down arrow until the copy setup item you want is  
highlighted and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the setup option you want is highlighted  
Option  
Scan Color  
Description  
Sets the color mode.  
and press OK.  
Scan Format  
Sets the file format in which the image is to be  
saved. If you select BMP, JPEG, TIFF, or PDF,  
you can select to scan multiple pages.  
6. Press the up/down arrow until the setting you want is highlighted and  
press OK.  
7. Repeat steps 4 through 6, as needed.  
8. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Depending on the selected scan type, this  
option may not appear.  
Change default  
Printing a report  
Option  
Scan Size  
Description  
Sets the image size.  
You can print a report on the machine's configuration or font list, etc.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Report and press OK.  
The scan size options may vary between  
document feeder or scanner glass.  
# of Copies  
Collation  
You can enter the number of copies using the  
number keypad.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the report or list you want to print  
highlights and press OK.  
To print all reports and lists, select All Reports.  
5. Press OK when Yes appears to confirm printing.  
The selected information prints out.  
Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy  
job in sets.  
Reduce/Enlarge  
Darkness  
Reduces or enlarges the size of a copied image.  
Adjusts the brightness level to make a copy that  
is easier to read, when the original contains faint  
markings and dark images.  
Option  
Description  
Configuration  
This list shows the status of the user-selectable  
options. You may print this list to confirm your  
changes after changing settings.  
Original Type  
Improves the copy quality by selecting the  
document type for the current copy job.  
Supplies Info.  
This item allows you to check how many pages  
are printed and how much toner are left in the  
cartridge.  
Scan setup  
Address Book  
Send Report  
This list shows all of the email addresses  
currently stored in the machine’s memory.  
Changing the scan setup options  
To avoid having to customize the scan settings for each job, you can set up  
default scan settings for each scan type.  
This report shows the fax number, the number of  
pages, the elapsed time of the job, the  
communication mode, and the communication  
results for a particular fax job.  
You can set up your machine to automatically  
print a transmission confirmation report after  
each fax job (See "Sending" on page 1).  
1. Press  
(Scan/Email) on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Scan Setup and press OK.  
4. Press OK when Change Default highlights .  
5. Press the up/down until the scan type you want is highlighted and press  
Sent Report  
This report shows information on the faxes and  
emails you have recently sent.  
You can set the machine to automatically print  
this report every 50 communications (See  
OK.  
6. Press the up/down until the scan setting option you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
Setting option is the same for each scan type.  
7. Press the up/down arrow until the desired status is highlighted and press  
Fax Rcv Report  
Scheduled Jobs  
This report shows information on the faxes you  
have recently received.  
OK.  
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 to set other setting options.  
9. When you have finished, press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
This list shows the documents currently stored  
for delayed faxes along with the starting time  
and type of each operation.  
Option  
Scan Size  
Description  
Sets the image size.  
JunkFax Report  
Network Info.  
This list shows the fax numbers specified as junk  
fax numbers. To add or delete numbers to or  
from this list, access the Junk Fax Setup menu  
The scan size options may vary between  
document feeder or scanner glass.  
This list shows information on your machine’s  
network connection and configuration.  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Sets the original document’s type.  
Sets the image resolution.  
Machine status and advanced feature_ 3  
   
Option  
Description  
Option  
Scan Setup  
Description  
User Auth List  
This list shows authorized users who are  
allowed to use the email function.  
Restores all of the scan options to the factory  
default.  
PCL Font List  
You can print the PCL font list.  
You can print the PS3 font list.  
System Setup  
Network Setup  
Address Book  
Restores all of the system options to the factory  
default.  
PS3 Font List  
Restores all of the network options to the factory  
default.  
Accounting Report  
This is used only when network authentication in  
enabled with SyncThru™ Web Service. Prints  
the report of printing out count for each login  
user.  
Clears all of the email address entries stored in  
memory.  
Sent Report  
Clears all records of sent faxes and emails.  
Clears all records of received faxes.  
Stored Joba  
This list shows the current status of stored job  
on hard disk drive (HDD).  
Fax Rcv Report  
Completed Joba  
The Completed Job page shows the list of  
completed print jobs. The list contains up to 50  
files from the latest print jobs.  
Network  
Net Auth Log  
Counter info.  
Fax Options  
This is shows users and their IDs who logged in  
the domain.  
You may set up the network with the machine's display screen. Before doing  
that, you must have the relevant information concerning the type of network  
protocols and computer system you use. If you are not sure which setting to  
use, contact your network administrator to configure this machine to the  
network.  
You can view the amount of each category that  
your machine has printed so far.  
You can set to print the information of a fax  
reports.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Network and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow until the setup option you want is highlighted  
a.This menu only appears when an optional hard disk drive (HDD) has  
been installed.  
and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the setting you want is highlighted and  
You can also print the machine's status information and browse status  
with SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the Web browser on your  
networked computer and type the IP address of your machine. When  
SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Information > Print  
information.  
press OK.  
5. Repeat steps 3 through 4, as needed.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Option  
Description  
TCP/IP (IPv4)  
TCP/IP (IPv6)  
Select appropriate protocol and configure  
parameters to use the network environment.  
Clearing memory  
You can selectively clear information stored in your machine’s memory.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Clear Setting and press OK.  
Ethernet Speed  
Configure the network transmission speed.  
Configure the wireless network environments.  
Wirelessa  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the item you want to clear highlights and  
Clear Setting  
Reverts the network settings to the default  
values.  
press OK.  
5. Press OK when Yes highlights to confirm clearing.  
6. Repeat steps 4 through 5 to clear another item.  
7. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Network Info.  
This list shows information on your machine’s  
network connection and configuration.  
a.This menu only appears when an optional wireless network interface  
has been installed.  
Some menus may not appear in the display depending on options or  
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.  
Document management  
Option  
All Settings  
Description  
Clears all of the data stored in memory and  
resets all of your settings to the factory default.  
This menu only appears when an optional hard disk drive (HDD) has been  
installed.  
This menu allows you to store the scanned documents in a box, set various  
options for stored documents and change the default settings for stored  
documents.  
Fax Setup  
Restores all of the fax options to the factory  
default.  
Copy Setup  
Restores all of the copy options to the factory  
default.  
To use this menu, you need to create a box first. Creating and editing  
the box can only be done through SyncThru™ Web Service (See  
Machine status and advanced feature_ 4  
       
Common Box is provided by default.  
Menu overview  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
The control panel provides access to various menus to set up the machine  
or use the machine’s functions. These menus can be accessed by pressing  
Menu.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Document Box and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow until the setup option you want is highlighted  
and press OK.  
Some menus may not appear in the display depending on options or  
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.  
Option  
Description  
Doc Box Feature  
Add From Scan: You can store scanned  
documents in a box. The stored file will be  
named automatically as  
"yearmonthdayhourminutesecond".  
Task From Box: You can print a document  
Items  
Option  
Fax Feature  
Darkness  
Resolution  
Scan Size  
Multi Send  
Delay Send  
Priority Send  
Forward  
Secure Receive  
Add Page  
from a box.  
Doc Box Setup  
Doc Box Report  
Add From Scan: You can set the default  
options for storing the document to a box.  
Task From Box: You can set the default  
options for printing the document from a box.  
You can print a report about documents stored  
in a box.  
Cancel Job  
Fax Setup  
Sending  
For the document stored in the Secure Box, you can set the  
Redial Times  
Redial Term  
Prefix Dial  
ECM Mode  
Send Report  
Image TCR  
password for accessing the document.  
Job management  
This menu item is avaidlable when the optional hard disk or memory is  
installed  
Dial Modea  
Receiving  
Receive Mode  
Ring To Answer  
Stamp RCV Name  
Rcv Start Code  
Auto Reduction  
Discard Size  
Junk Fax Setup  
DRPD Modea  
Duplex Print  
Doc Box Savingb  
Change Default  
Resolution  
Darkness  
Scan Size  
Auto Report  
Copy Feature  
Scan Size  
Reduce/Enlarge  
Darkness  
Original Type  
Layout  
Adjust Bkgd  
Margin Shift  
Edge Erase  
Gray Enhance  
WaterMark  
Machine status and advanced feature_ 5  
     
Items  
Option  
Items  
Option  
Copy Setup  
Change Default  
Scan Size  
System Setup  
Machine Setup  
Machine ID  
# of Copies  
Collation  
Machine Fax No.  
Date & Time  
Reduce/Enlarge  
Darkness  
Original Type  
Clock Mode  
Form Menub  
Select Formb  
Language  
Scan Feature  
USB Feature  
Default Mode  
Power Save  
Timeout  
Scan Size  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
Scan Format  
Email Feature  
Scan Size  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
FTP Feature  
Scan Size  
Job Timeout  
Altitude Adjust  
Auto Continue  
Paper Substitution  
Net Accounting  
Import Setting  
Export Setting  
Color Report  
Paper Setup  
Paper Size  
Paper Type  
Paper Source  
Wide A4  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
SMB Feature  
Scan Size  
Sound/Volume  
Key Sound  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
Alarm Sound  
Speaker  
Ringer  
Report  
Scan Setup  
Change Default  
USB Feature  
Scan Size  
All Reports  
Configuration  
Supplies Info.  
Address Book  
Send Report  
Sent Report  
Fax Rcv Report  
Scheduled Jobs  
JunkFax Report  
Network Info.  
User Auth List  
PCL Font List  
PS Font List  
Accounting Report  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
Scan Format  
Email Feature  
Scan Size  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
Scan Format  
FTP Feature  
Scan Size  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
Scan Format  
SMB Feature  
Scan Size  
Stored Jobb  
Completed Jobb  
Net Auth Log  
Counter info.  
Fax Options  
Maintenance  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Scan Color  
Scan Format  
Send Report  
CLR Empty Msgc  
Supplies Life  
Color  
Serial Number  
Toner Low Alert  
Machine status and advanced feature_ 6  
 
d.This menu only appears when an optional wireless network interface  
has been installed.  
Items  
Option  
System Setup  
Clear Setting  
All Settings  
Fax Setup  
Copy Setup  
Scan Setup  
System Setup  
Network Setup  
Address Book  
Sent Report  
Fax Rcv Report  
Job Managementb  
Active Job  
Stored Job  
File Policy  
Image Overwriteb  
Immediate  
On Demand  
Network  
TCP/IP (IPv4)  
DHCP  
BOOTP  
Static  
IP Address  
Primary DNS  
Secondary DNS  
TCP/IP (IPv6)  
IPv6 Activate  
DHCPv6 Config  
Ethernet Speed  
Auto  
10M Half  
10M Full  
100M Half  
100M Full  
Wirelessd  
WLAN Settings  
Wizard  
Custom  
WLAN Default  
WLAN Signal  
Clear Setting  
Network Info.  
Document Boxb  
Doc Box Feature  
Task From Box  
Add From Scan  
Doc Box Setup  
Task From Box  
Add From Scan  
Doc Box Report  
a.This setting may not be available depending on your country.  
b.This menu only appears when an optional hard disk drive (HDD) has  
been installed.  
c. This menu only appears when the toner cartridge has almost reached  
its estimated cartridge life.  
Machine status and advanced feature_ 7  
1.  
management tools  
This chapter introduces management tools provided to help you make full use of your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
Some tabs may not appear depending on your model.  
Introducing useful management tools  
Information tab  
The programs below help you to use your machine conveniently.  
This tab gives you general information about your machine. You can  
check things, such as the machine’s IP address, remaining amount of  
toner, ethernet information, firmware version and more. You can also  
print reports such as an error report and so on.  
Active Alerts: This item allows you to check the alerts occurred in the  
machine and their severity.  
Supplies: This item allows you to check how many pages are printed  
Using SyncThru™ Web Service  
and amount of toner left in the cartridge.  
Internet Explorer 6.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for  
SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Usage Counters: This item allows you to check the usage count by  
print types:simplex, duplex.  
Current Settings: This item allows you to check the machine and  
network information.  
Print information: This item allows you to print reports such as  
If you have connected your machine to a network and set up TCP/IP  
network parameters correctly, you can manage the machine via SyncThru™  
Web Service, an embedded web server. Use SyncThru™ Web Service to:  
system related reports, e mail address and font reports.  
View the machine’s device information and check its current status.  
Change TCP/IP parameters and set up other network parameters.  
Change printer preference.  
Set the email notifications advising of the machine’s status.  
Get support for using the machine.  
Box tab  
This tab only appears when an optional hard disk drive (HDD) is  
installed.  
You can save PC-printed, faxed, scanned or copied documents in the  
User Box or System Box and print the saved documents.  
To access SyncThru™ Web Service:  
1. Access a web browser, such as Internet Explorer, from Windows.  
Enter the machine IP address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address  
field and press the Enter key or click Go.  
2. Your machine’s embedded website opens.  
When saving the document using the Add from Scan menu in the  
control panel, you can choose the box to save the scanned  
document from the below.  
Common Box: This box is provided by default. Received faxes  
are stored in this box. Allows you to store received faxes if Doc  
Box Saving menu in the control panel is On. You cannot  
delete this box.  
Public Box: This box can be created by a user.  
Secure Box: This box is created by a user. You can set the  
password for accessing this box.  
Logging into SyncThru™ Web Service  
Before configuring options in SyncThru™ Web Service, you need to  
log-in as an administrator. You can still use SyncThru™ Web Service  
without logging in but you won’t have access to Settings tab and  
Security tab.  
User Box: Only received fax and scanned documents will be saved in  
this box. Types of boxes provided may differ depending on the  
model you are using.  
System Box: You can save the documents from the system.  
-Secured Received Fax: Allows you to store received faxes if  
Secure Receive menu in the control panel is On.  
1.Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service  
website.  
A log-in page appears.  
2.Type in the ID and Password then click Login .  
If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the  
below default ID and password.  
-Stored Print: Allows you to print documents which you have saved  
as Store, Proof or Print Schedule in the printer driver’s Job  
Setting option.  
ID: admin  
Password: sec00000  
-Secured Print: Allows you to print documents which you have  
SyncThru™ Web Service overview  
saved as Confidential in the printer driver’s Job Setting option.  
Management tools_ 1  
       
Address Book tab  
E-mail notification setup  
You can store contact information such as name, speed no, e-mail  
address and so on. For grouping individual addresses, Fax Group entry  
and E-mail Group entry are ready.  
You can receive emails about your machine’s status by setting this option.  
By setting information such as IP address, host name, e-mail address and  
SMTP server information, the machine status (toner cartridge shortage or  
machine error) will be sent to a certain person's e-mail automatically. This  
option may be used more frequently by a machine administrator.  
Individual: You can create an individual address book. Click the Add  
button.  
1. Start a web browser, such as Internet Explorer, from Windows.  
Fax Groups: You can create fax group address books. You can add  
users by clicking the Add button or by dragging the user from  
Individual group to Fax Groups.  
Enter the machine IP address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address  
field and press the Enter key or click Go.  
E-mail Groups: You can create e-mail group address books. You can  
add users by clicking the Add button or by dragging the user from  
Individual group to E-mail Groups.  
2. Your machine’s embedded website opens.  
3. From the Settings tab, select Machine Settings > E-mail Notification.  
If you haven’t configured outgoing server environment, go to  
Settings > Network Settings > Outgoing Mail Server(SMTP) to  
configure network environment before setting e-mail notification.  
Setting tab  
This tab allows you to set configurations provided by your machine and  
network. You need to log-in as an administrator to view this tab.  
Machine Settings tab: This tab allows you to set options provided by  
4. Click Add button to add e-mail notification user.  
Set the recipient name and e-mail address(es) with notification items  
you want to receive an alert for.  
your machine.  
-System: You can set settings related to your machine.  
-Printer: You can set settings related to printing jobs.  
-Copy: You can set settings related to copying jobs.  
-Fax: You can set settings related to faxing jobs.  
-Scan: You can set settings related to scanning jobs.  
5. Click Apply.  
If the firewall is activated, the e-mail may not be sent successfully. In  
that case, contact the a network administrator.  
Setting the system administrator information  
Set the the system administrator information. This setting is necessary for  
using the e-mail notification option.  
-E-mail Notification: You can set e-mail notification feature and  
e-mail address of recipients who will receive the notification.  
Network Settings tab: This tab allows you to view and change the  
network environment. You can set things, such as TCP/IP, network  
protocols and so on.  
1. Start a web browser, such as Internet Explorer, from Windows.  
Enter the machine IP address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address  
field and press the Enter key or click Go.  
2. Your machine’s embedded website opens.  
3. From the Security tab, select System Security > System  
-SNMP: You can exchange of management information between  
network devices using SNMP.  
-Outgoing Mail Server(SMTP): You can set the outgoing E-mail  
server.  
Administrator  
4. Enter the name of the administrator, phone number, location and E-mail  
-Restore Default: You can restore default network settings.  
address.  
5. Click Apply.  
Security tab  
This tab allows you to set system and network security information. You  
need to log-in as an administrator to view this tab.  
System Security: You can set the system administrator’s information  
and also enable or disable machine features.  
Network Security: You can set settings for HTTPs, IPSec, IPv4/IPv6  
filtering, 802.1x, Authentication servers.  
User Access Control: You can set configurations for user  
Using the Smart Panel program  
Smart Panel is a program that monitors and informs you of the machine  
status, and allows you to customize the machine’s settings. For Windows  
and Macintosh, Smart Panel is installed automatically when you install the  
machine software. For Linux, you can download Smart Panel from  
Samsung website and install (See "Installing the SmartPanel" on page 5).  
accessibility.  
To use this program, you need the following system requirements:  
Maintenance tab  
This tab allows you to maintain your machine by upgrading firmwares  
and setting contact information for sending emails. You can also connect  
to Samsung website or download drivers by selecting the Link menu.  
Windows. Check for windows operating system(s) compatible with  
your machine (See "System requirements" on page 2).  
Mac OS X 10.3 or higher.  
Linux. Check for Linux systems that are compatible with your  
Firmware Update: You can upgrade your machine’s firmware.  
Internet Explorer version 5.0 or higher for flash animation in HTML  
Help.  
Contact Information: You can view the contact information.  
Link: You can view the links to useful sites where you can download  
orcheck information.  
Understanding Smart Panel  
If an error occurs while printing, you can check the error from the Smart  
Panel.  
You can also launch Smart Panel manually. Double-click the Smart Panel  
icon on the Windows task bar (in Windows), or Notification Area (in Linux).  
You can also click it on the status bar (in Mac OS X).  
Management tools_ 2  
   
Changing the Smart Panel Program Settings  
Right-click (in Windows or Linux) or click (in Mac OS X) the Smart Panel  
icon and select Options. Select the settings you want from the Options  
window.  
Windows  
Double-click this icon in Windows.  
Macintosh  
Linux  
Click this icon in Mac OS X.  
Click this icon in Linux.  
Smarthru Office  
The supplied software CD provides you with SmarThru Office. SmarThru  
Office offers you convenient features to use with your machine.  
Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select  
Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your machine name >  
Smart Panel.  
Starting SmarThru Office  
Follow the steps below to start SmarThru Office:  
If you have already installed more than one Samsung machine, first  
select the correct machine model you want in order to access the  
corresponding Smart Panel.  
1. Make sure that your machine and computer are turned on and properly  
connected to each other.  
2. Once you have installed SmarThru Office, you will see the SmarThru  
Right-click (in Windows or Linux) or click (in Mac OS X) the Smart  
Panel icon and select your machine.  
Office icon on your desktop.  
3. Double-click the SmarThru Office icon.  
The Smart Panel window and its contents shown in this user’s guide  
may differ depending on the machine or operating system in use.  
The Smart Panel program displays the current status of the machine, the  
estimated level of toner remaining in the toner cartridge(s), and various  
other types of information. You can also change settings.  
This menu displays direct buttons for some features. The direct  
buttons include: Categories, Binder, Life Cycle, Scan and OCR,  
Fix and Enhance and Samsung Website. You can disable this  
menu by checking “Do not show this diaglog again”.  
4. The SmarThru Office appears.  
For more information about SmarThru Office, click Help > SmarThru  
Office help. The SmarThru Office Help window appears; you can view  
on screen help supplied on the SmarThru program.  
Toner Level  
View the level of toner remaining in the toner  
cartridge(s). The machine and the number of toner  
cartridge(s) shown in the above window may differ  
depending on the machine in use. Some machines  
do not have this feature.  
Click the SmarThru icon  
in the tray area of the Windows taskbar  
1
2
to activate the SmarThru Office launcher.  
Buy Now  
Order replacement toner cartridge(s) online.  
User’s Guide  
View User’s Guide.  
Follow the steps below to uninstall SmarThru Office.  
Before you begin the uninstall, ensure that all applications are closed  
on your computer.  
This button changes to Troubleshooting  
Guide when error occurs. You can directly  
open troubleshooting section in the user’s  
guide.  
3
a)From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs.  
b)Select SmarThru Office, and then select Uninstall SmarThru  
Printer  
Setting  
Configure various machine settings in the Printer  
Settings Utility window. Some machines do not  
have this feature.  
Office.  
c)When your computer asks you to confirm your selection, read the  
statement and click OK.  
d)Click Finish.  
4
5
If you connect your machine to a network,  
the SyncThru™ Web Service window  
appears instead of the Printer Settings Utility  
window.  
Using SmarThru Office  
Scanning  
Driver Setting Set all of the machine options you need in the  
Printing Preferences window. This feature is  
available only for Windows (See "Opening printing  
1.Click the SmarThru icon  
in the tray area of the windows taskbar to  
activate the SmarThru Office launcher.  
2.Click the scanning icon to open the scanning window.  
Management tools_ 3  
     
3.Scan Setting window opens.  
Sending a file to FTP  
You can upload files to an FTP server while working on SmarThru  
Office.  
1.Double-click the SmarThru Office icon on your desktop.  
2.Select the file to send to FTP.  
3.Select File > Send to > Send By FTP.  
4.Send By FTP window opens.  
5.Add your file and click Upload.  
Email  
You can send email while working on SmarThru Office.  
You need an email client program, such as Outlook Express, to  
send email in SmarThru Office. Procedure for sending email may  
differ depending on email client program you are using.  
1.Double-click the SmarThru Office icon on your desktop.  
2.Select the file to send to Email.  
3.Select File > Send to> Send By E-mail.  
4.An email client opens.  
5.Type in necessary information and send your email.  
Select  
Scanner  
Allows you to select between the Local or Network  
scanner.  
1
2
3
4
Select  
Profile  
Allows you to save settings frequently used for  
future use. Click New Profile to save the setting.  
Using the Unified Linux Driver Configurator  
Scan  
Settings  
Allows you to customize settings for Scan Size  
and Paper Source.  
Unified Driver Configurator is a tool primarily intended for configuring  
machine devices. You need to install Unified Linux Driver to use Unified  
Scan To  
Allows you to customize settings for File Name  
and location to send scanned data.  
After the driver is installed on your Linux system, the Unified Driver  
Configurator icon will automatically be created on your desktop.  
Click Advanced button to set more scan options.  
4.Set scan settings and click Scan.  
Opening the Unified Driver Configurator  
1. Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator on the desktop.  
Printing  
You can also click the Startup Menu icon and select Samsung Unified  
Driver > Unified Driver Configurator.  
2. Click each button on the left to switch to the corresponding configuration  
1.Click the SmarThru icon  
in the tray area of the Windows taskbar to  
active the SmarThru Office launcher.  
window.  
2.Click the printing icon  
to open the printing window.  
3.Select the file you want to print.  
4.Select the machine you want to use for printing.  
5.Click Print to start the job.  
Sending a file via fax  
You can fax while working on SmarThru Office.  
1.Click the SmarThru icon  
in the tray area of the Windows taskbar to  
active the SmarThru Office launcher.  
2.Click the faxing icon  
to open the faxing window.  
3.Set fax settings and click Send Fax.  
1 Printers  
Select Fax Machine: Choose whether the machine is connected  
locally or via network. If the machine is in network, click Browse  
to insert the IP address and other information.  
Configuration  
2 Scanners  
Configuration  
Pages Ready: Select file you want to fax. Click Add.  
3 Ports  
Recipients: Click Add to enter the fax number.  
Configuration  
Cover page: If you need a cover page, enter the values for the  
options. If not, click Skip Cover Page.  
Fax Settings: If the original document is faded or not vivid, click  
To use the on screen help, click Help.  
Fine. In this case, the fax speed could be low.  
3. After changing the configurations, click Exit to close the Unified Driver  
Configurator.  
Management tools_ 4  
 
Classes tab  
The Classes tab shows a list of available machine classes.  
Printers configuration  
Printers configuration has the two tabs: Printers and Classes.  
Printers tab  
View the current system’s printer configuration by clicking on the  
machine icon button on the left side of the Unified Driver Configurator  
window.  
Shows all of the machine classes.  
1
2
Shows the status of the class and the number of machines in the  
class.  
Refresh: Renews the classes list.  
Add Class: Allows you to add a new machine class.  
Remove Class: Removes the selected machine class.  
Switches to Printers configuration.  
1
Shows all of the installed machine.  
2
Shows the status, model name and URI of your machine.  
3
Scanners configuration  
In this window, you can monitor the activity of scanner devices, view a list of  
installed Samsung machine devices, change device properties and scan  
images.  
The printer control buttons are, as follows:  
Refresh: Renews the available machines list.  
Add Printer: Allows you to add a new machines.  
Remove Printer: Removes the selected machine.  
Set as Default: Sets the current selected machine as a default  
machine.  
Stop/Start: Stops/starts the machine.  
Test: Allows you to print a test page to ensure the machine is working  
properly.  
Properties: Allows you to view and change the printer properties.  
Switches to Scanners configuration.  
1
Shows all of the installed scanners.  
2
Shows the vendor, model name and type of your scanner.  
3
Management tools_ 5  
Properties: Allows you to change the scan properties and scan a  
document.  
Ports configuration  
In this window, you can view the list of available ports, check the status of  
each port and release a port that is stalled in a busy state when its owner  
has terminated the job for any reason.  
Switches to Ports configuration.  
1
Shows all of the available ports.  
2
Shows the port type, device connected to the port, and status.  
3
Refresh: Renews the available ports list.  
Release port: Releases the selected port.  
Sharing Ports Between Printers and Scanners  
Your machine may be connected to a host computer via a parallel port  
or USB port. Since the machine device contains more than one device  
(printer and scanner), it is necessary to organize proper access of  
“consumer” applications to these devices via the single I/O port.  
The Unified Linux Driver package provides an appropriate port sharing  
mechanism that is used by Samsung printer and scanner drivers. The  
drivers talk to their devices via so-called machine ports. The current  
status of any machine port can be viewed via the Ports configuration.  
The port sharing prevents you from accessing one functional block of  
the machine device, while another block is in use.  
When you install a new machine device onto your system, it is strongly  
recommended you do this with the assistance of an Unified Driver  
Configurator. In this case you will be asked to choose I/O port for the  
new device. This choice will provide the most suitable configuration for  
machine’s functionality. For machine scanners, I/O ports are being  
chosen by scanner drivers automatically, so proper settings are applied  
by default.  
Management tools_ 6  
1.  
maintenance  
This chapter provides information for maintaining your machine and the toner cartridge.  
This chapter includes:  
Printing a machine report  
Option  
Description  
You can print the machine's information and job report.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Report and press OK.  
Custom Color  
This menu allows you to adjust contrast, color by  
color.  
Default: Optimizes colors automatically.  
Manual Adjust: Allows you to manually  
adjust the color contrast for each cartridge.  
4. Press the up/down arrow until the report or list you want to print appears  
and press OK.  
To print all reports and lists, select All Reports.  
It is recommended to use the Default setting for  
best color quality.  
5. Press the left/right arrow to highlight Yes at the Printing? prompt and  
Auto Color Reg.  
You can adjust the position of color texts or  
graphics to match the position of the printed  
colors to those on your screen.  
press OK.  
You can use SyncThru™ Web Service to print the machine's  
configuration or browse the status. Open the web browser in the  
networked computer and type the machine's IP address. When  
SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Information > Print  
Information Sheet.  
If you have moved the machine, it is  
strongly recommended to operate this  
menu manually.  
Density Controla  
Density Adjustmenta  
Density Sensinga  
The machine automatically calibrates the toner  
density of machine for the best possible color  
print quality.  
If you select Off, the machine is calibrated by  
the factory default toner density.  
Monitoring the supplies life  
To view the supply life indicators, follow the steps below:  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
This item allows you to quickly adjust color  
density. You can easily adjust the color density  
and see the result right away but it’s not a  
permenant adjustment. Use this item to get a  
quick result.  
2. Press up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press up/down arrow to highlight Maintenance and press OK.  
4. Press up/down arrow to highlight Supplies Life and press OK.  
5. The display shows options as you press up/down arrow.  
6. When you select the option, press OK to browse the life.  
Automatically calculates the reduced or worn out  
supplies like toner or machine parts and uses  
this information to adjust the color density. For  
example, if the yellow toner is running out, the  
machine calculates the amount of remaining  
yellow toner and adjusts color density so the  
printouts are fine.  
Adjusting the color contrast  
Color menu allows you to adjust the color setting.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press up/down arrow to highlight Maintenance and press OK.  
4. Press up/down arrow to highlight Color and press OK.  
5. The display shows options as you press up/down arrow.  
Density Calibrationa  
You can manually calibrate the toner density of  
machine for the best possible color print quality.  
a.CLX-6250 Series only.  
Finding the serial number  
When you call for service or register as a user on the Samsung website, the  
machine’s serial number by taking the following steps:  
Maintenance_ 1  
           
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the green release handle to release the paper transfer belt.  
Holding the handle on the paper transfer belt, lift it out of the machine do  
not touch surface of belt.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Maintenance and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Serial Number and press OK.  
5. Check your machine’s serial number.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Using Toner Low Alert  
If toner in the cartridge has run out, a message informing user to change the  
toner cartridge appears. You can set the option for this message to appear  
or not.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press up/down arrow to highlight Maintenance and press OK.  
4. Press up/down arrow to highlight Toner Low Alert and press OK.  
Cleaning a machine  
When you open the front door and work inside the machine, it is  
highly recommend that you remove the paper transfer belt first.  
Because the work you do could contaminate the paper transfer  
belt.  
If printing quality problems occur or if you use your machine in a dusty  
environment, you need to clean your machine regularly to keep the best  
printing condition and use your machine longer.  
Cleaning the cabinet of the machine with cleaning materials  
containing large amounts of alcohol, solvent, or other strong  
substances can discolor or distort the cabinet.  
4. Grasp the handles on the toner cartridge and pull the cartridge out.  
If your machine or the surrounding area is contaminated with toner,  
we recommend you use cloth or tissue dampened with water to  
clean it. If you use a vacuum cleaner, toner blows in the air and  
might be harmful to you.  
Cleaning the outside  
Clean the machine cabinet with a soft, lint-free cloth. Dampen the cloth  
slightly with water, but be careful not to let any water drip onto or into the  
machine.  
Cleaning the inside  
During the printing process, paper, toner and dust particles can accumulate  
inside the machine. This buildup can cause print quality problems, such as  
toner specks or smearing. Cleaning the inside of the machine clears and  
reduces these problems.  
1. Turn the machine off and unplug the power cord. Wait for the machine to  
cool down.  
If you open the front door, be careful not to touch the underneath  
the control panel (the lower part of the fuser unit). The temperature  
of the fuser unit might be extremely hot and could damage your  
skin.  
2. Using the handle, completely open the front door.  
Maintenance_ 2  
     
5. With a dry, lint-free cloth, wipe away any dust and spilled toner from the  
8. Holding the handle on the paper transfer belt, align it with the slots on  
toner cartridge area.  
the inside of the front door.  
9. Lower the paper transfer belt until it is parallel with the front door and  
While cleaning the inside of the machine, be careful not to damage  
the transfer roller or any other inside parts. Do not use solvents  
such as benzene or thinner to clean. Printing quality problems can  
occur and cause damage to the machine.  
firmly seated.  
6. Locate the long strip of glass (LSU) inside the machine and using a  
cotton swab, gently clean the 4 pieces of LSU glass.  
10. Close the front door. Ensure that the cover is securely closed.  
If the front door is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
11. Plug in the power cord and turn the machine on.  
7. Slide the toner cartridge back into the machine.  
Cleaning the scan unit  
Keeping the scan unit clean helps ensure the best possible copies. We  
suggest that you clean the scan unit at the start of each day and during the  
day, as needed.  
1. Slightly dampen a soft, lint-free cloth or paper towel with water.  
2. Open the scanner lid.  
3. Wipe the surface of the scanner glass and the document feeder glass  
until it is clean and dry.  
Maintenance_ 3  
 
Use of non-Samsung and refilled toner cartridge  
Samsung Electronics does not recommend or approve the use of  
non-Samsung brand toner cartridges in your printer including generic, store  
brand, refilled, or remanufactured toner cartridges.  
Samsung’s printer warranty does not cover damage to the machine  
caused by the use of a refilled, remanufactured, or non-Samsung  
brand toner cartridge.  
Estimated cartridge life  
Estimated cartridge life (the life of the toner cartridge yield) depends on the  
amount of toner that print jobs require. The actual print-out number may  
vary depending on the print density of the pages you print on, operating  
environment, printing interval, media type, and/or media size. For example,  
if you print a lot of graphics, the consumption of the toner is high and you  
may need to change the cartridge more often.  
1 Scanner lid  
2 Scanner glass  
3 Document feeder  
glass  
Tips for moving & storing your machine  
4 White bar  
When moving the machine, do not tilt or turn it upside down. Otherwise,  
the inside of the machine may be contaminated by toner, which can  
cause damage to the machine or bad print quality.  
When moving the machine, make sure at least two people are holding  
the machine securely.  
4. Wipe the underside of the scanner lid and white sheet until it is clean  
and dry.  
5. Close the scanner lid.  
Storing the toner cartridge  
When moving the machine or when machine is not in use for a long time,  
lock the scanner lock.  
Toner cartridges contain components that are sensitive to light, temperature  
and humidity. Samsung suggests users follow the recommendations below  
to ensure the optimum performance, highest quality and longest life from  
your new Samsung toner cartridges.  
Store this cartridge in the same environment as the printer it will be used in;  
this should be in controlled office temperature and humidity conditions. The  
toner cartridge should remain in its original, unopened package until  
installation – If original packaging is not available, cover the top opening of  
the cartridge with paper and store in a dark cabinet.  
Opening the cartridge package prior to use dramatically shortens its useful  
shelf and operating life. Do not store on the floor. If the toner cartridge is  
removed from the printer, always store the cartridge:  
Inside the protective bag from the original package.  
Store lying flat (not standing on end) with the same side facing up as if  
they were installed in the machine.  
Do not store consumables in;  
-Temperature greater than 40°C (104°F).  
-Humidity range less than 20% nor not greater than 80%.  
-An environment with extreme changes in humidity or temperature.  
-Direct sunlight or room light.  
-Dusty places.  
-A car for a long period of time.  
-An environment where corrosive gases are present.  
-An environment with salty air.  
Handling instructions  
Do not touch the surface of the photosensitive drum in the cartridge.  
Do not expose the cartridge to unnecessary vibrations or shock.  
Never manually rotate the drum, especially in the reverse direction; this  
can cause internal damage and toner spillage.  
Maintenance_ 4  
   
1.  
troubleshooting  
This chapter gives helpful information for what to do if you encounter an error.  
This chapter includes:  
If you open the front door, be careful not to touch the underneath  
the control panel (the lower part of the fuser unit). The temperature  
of the fuser unit might be extremely hot and could damage your  
skin.  
Redistributing toner  
When the toner cartridge is near the end of its life:  
White streaks or light printing occurs.  
The toner-related message saying that the toner is low may appear on  
the display.  
The Status LED blinks red.  
If this happens, you can temporarily improve print quality by redistributing  
the remaining toner in the cartridge. In some cases, white streaks or light  
printing will still occur even after you have redistributed the toner.  
1. Using the handle, completely open the front door.  
When you open the front door and work inside the machine, it is  
highly recommend that you remove the paper transfer belt first.  
Because the work you do could contaminate the paper transfer  
belt.  
3. Holding both handles on the toner cartridge, thoroughly rock it from side  
to side to redistribute the toner.  
2. Grasp the handles on the toner cartridge and pull the cartridge out.  
If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash  
clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric.  
4. Hold the toner cartridge by the handle and slowly insert the cartridge into  
the opening in the machine.  
Tabs on the sides of the cartridge and corresponding grooves within the  
machine will guide the cartridge into the correct position until it locks into  
Troubleshooting_ 1  
     
place completely.  
3. Gently remove the original jammed from the document feeder.  
4. Close the document feeder cover. Reload the pages you removed, if  
any, in the document feeder.  
5. Close the front door. Ensure that the cover is securely closed.  
If the front door is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
Exit misfeed  
1. Remove any remaining pages from the document feeder.  
2. Remove the misfeed original, and remove the sheets from the document  
output tray by carefully pulling it to the right using both hands.  
Clearing original document jams  
When an original jams while passing through the document feeder, a  
warning message appears on the display screen.  
To avoid tearing the document, remove the jammed document slowly  
and gently.  
To prevent document jams, use the scanner glass for thick, thin, or  
mixed paper-type originals.  
Input misfeed  
1. Remove any remaining pages from the document feeder.  
2. Open the document feeder cover.  
3. Load the removed pages back into the document feeder.  
Roller misfeed  
1. Open the scanner lid.  
2. Remove the misfeed original, and remove the sheets from the feed area  
by carefully pulling it to the right using both hands.  
Troubleshooting_ 2  
 
2. Pull out tray 1 .  
1 scanner lid  
3. Close the scanner lid. Load the removed pages back into the document  
feeder.  
3. Remove the jammed paper by pulling in the direction shown. To avoid  
tearing the paper, pull it out gently and slowly.  
Tips for avoiding paper jams  
By selecting the correct media types, most paper jams can be avoided.  
When a paper jam occurs, refer to the next guidelines.  
Ensure that the adjustable guides are positioned correctly (See "Loading  
Do not overload the tray. Ensure that the paper level is below the paper  
capacity mark on the inside of the tray.  
Do not remove paper from the tray while your machine is printing.  
Flex, fan and straighten paper before loading.  
Do not use creased, damp, or highly curled paper.  
Do not mix paper types in a tray.  
Use only recommended print media (See "Setting the paper size and  
Ensure that the recommended side of the print media is facing up in the  
tray, or facing down in the multi-purpose tray.  
If the paper does not move when you pull, or if you do not see the paper  
in this area, check the fuser area around the toner cartridge (See "Inside  
Clearing paper jams  
When a paper jam occurs, a warning message appears on the display  
screen.  
4. Insert tray 1 back into the machine until it snaps into place. Printing  
automatically resumes.  
To avoid tearing the paper, pull the jammed paper out slowly and  
gently. Follow the instructions in the following sections to clear the  
jam.  
In optional tray 2  
In tray 1  
1. Open and close the front door. The jammed paper is automatically  
ejected from the machine.  
If the paper does not exit, go to the next step.  
Troubleshooting_ 3  
         
1. Pull out optional tray 2.  
4. Open the inner cover while you are pushing the lever with two hands.  
2. Remove the jammed paper by pulling in the direction shown. To avoid  
tearing the paper, pull it out gently and slowly.  
5. Pull the paper out gently.  
If the paper does not move when you pull or if you do not see the paper  
in this area, stop and go to the next step.  
3. Pull tray 1 half-way out.  
4. If you see the jammed paper, remove the paper from the machine by  
6. Replace the tray.  
7. Open and close the front door to resume printing.  
gently pulling it straight out.  
If the front door is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
5. Insert the trays back into the machine. Printing automatically resumes.  
In the multi-purpose tray  
Inside the machine  
1. If the paper is not feeding properly, pull the paper out of the machine.  
The fuser area is hot. Take care when removing paper from the  
machine.  
1. Using the handle, completely open the front door.  
If you cannot find the jammed paper, or if there is any resistance  
removing the paper, stop pulling and go to step 2.  
Be careful not to scratch the surface of the paper transfer belt.  
2. Close the multi-purpose tray.  
3. Pull the tray out.  
Troubleshooting_ 4  
   
2. Press the green release handle to release the paper transfer belt.  
5. Lower the paper transfer belt until it is parallel with the front door and  
Holding the handle on the paper transfer belt, lift it out of the machine.  
firmly seated.  
3. Remove the jammed paper by pulling in the direction shown. To avoid  
6. Close the front door to resume printing.  
tearing the paper, pull it out gently and slowly.  
If the front door is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
In exit area  
1. Open and close the front door. The jammed paper is automatically  
ejected from the machine.  
If you do not see the jammed paper, go to next step.  
2. Gently pull the paper out of the output tray.  
4. Holding the handle on the paper transfer belt, align it with the slots on  
the inside of the front door.  
If you do not see the jammed paper or if there is any resistance when  
you pull, stop and go to the next step.  
Troubleshooting_ 5  
 
3. Open the scan unit.  
6. Pull up the paper jam lever in the direction of the arrow to separate the  
fuser rollers and carefully remove the jammed paper from the unit.  
When the scanner lid is open, the scan unit cannot be opened. Do  
not force the scan unit open, it can cause damage to the machine.  
Close the scanner lid before opening the scan unit.  
7. Press down the paper jam lever to reapply pressure to the rollers.  
8. Close the inner cover.  
4. Open the fuser cover.  
5. Open the inner cover.  
Before closing the inner cover, the jam lever must be fastened first  
(step7). Otherwise, paper jam can occur.  
If you do not see the jammed paper or if there is any resistance when  
you pull, stop and go to the next step.  
9. Open the inner cover of reverse unit and carefully remove the jammed  
paper out of the machine.  
Do not touch the fuser inside the inner cover. It is hot and could  
cause burns!  
If there is any resistance removing the paper or difficulty picking up  
jammed paper, stop pulling and turn the release knob to the direction as  
Troubleshooting_ 6  
shown to remove the misfed paper.  
In the duplex unit area  
1. Open the front door.  
Be careful not to scratch the surface of the paper transfer belt.  
10. Close the inner cover of the reverse unit.  
11. Lowering down the scan unit gently and slowly until it is completely  
2. Press the green release handle to release the paper transfer belt.  
closed. Make sure that it is securely latched.  
Be careful not to pinch your fingers!  
Holding the handle on the paper transfer belt, lift it out of the machine.  
3. Remove the jammed paper by pulling in the direction shown. To avoid  
tearing the paper, pull it out gently and slowly.  
If the scan unit is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
If you do not see the jammed paper or if there is any resistance when  
you pull, stop and go to the next step.  
12. Open the rear cover and carefully take the jammed paper out of the  
machine.  
13. Close the rear cover.  
Troubleshooting_ 7  
 
4. Holding the handle on the paper transfer belt, align it with the slots on  
job again. If the problem persists, call for service.  
the inside of the front door.  
When you call for service, provide the service representative with the  
contents of display message and the serial number.  
Some messages may not appear in the display depending on options  
or models.  
[aaa] indicates the error code. When you contact the service center,  
this error code help to handle the problem.  
[ccc] indicates the part of the each toner cartridge.  
[xxx] indicates the media type.  
[zzz] indicates the paper size.  
[yyy] indicates the tray.  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
[ccc] toner cart.  
error  
Error: [aaa]  
Open/Close Door  
The toner cartridge is  
wrong installed.  
Open and close the  
front door; and check  
that the toner cartridge’s  
are installed correctly. If  
the problem persists,  
call for service.  
Prepare new [ccc]  
toner  
Prepare new [ccc]  
toner cartridge  
Small amount of toner is  
left in the cartridge. The  
estimated cartridge life of may temporarily  
Prepare a new cartridge  
for replacement. You  
5. Lower the paper transfer belt until it is parallel with the front door and  
firmly seated.  
toner is close.  
increase the printing  
quality by redistributing  
the toner (See  
page 1).  
6. Close the front door to resume printing.  
If the front door is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
Understanding display messages  
Messages appear on the control panel display to indicate the machine’s  
status or errors. Some error messages are shown with graphics to aid you in  
troubleshooting.  
Checking display messages  
1. When errors occur, Check Error appears on the display and press OK.  
2. Check the display message to see what kind of error has occurred.  
If several messages appear, press the up/down arrow to highlight the  
message you want solve.  
3. Press OK on the control panel.  
Refer to the tables below to understand the messages’ and their  
meaning, and solve the problem, using the suggested solutions.  
If Check Error still appears, repeat above steps.  
If a message is not in the table, reboot the power and try the printing  
Troubleshooting_ 8  
   
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Replace new [ccc]  
toner  
Replace with new  
[ccc] toner cartridge  
The indicated toner  
cartridge has almost  
reached its estimated  
cartridge life. The  
machine might stop  
printing.  
You can choose Stop  
or Continue as  
[ccc] toner Not  
Installed  
[ccc] toner cartridge  
is not installed.  
Install it  
The toner cartridge is not Reinstall the toner  
installed or the CRUM  
(Consumer Replaceable  
Unit Monitor) in the  
cartridge is not properly  
connected.  
cartridge two or three  
times. If the problem  
persists, the toner  
cartridge is not being  
detected. Call for  
service.  
shown on the control  
panel. If you select  
Stop, the printer  
stops printing and  
you cannot print any  
more without  
changing the  
cartridge. If you  
select Continue, the  
printer keeps printing  
but the printing  
Estimatedcartridge  
life means the  
expected or  
estimated toner  
cartridge life, which  
indicates the  
average capacity of  
print-outs and is  
designed pursuant  
to ISO/IEC 19798.  
The number of  
pages may be  
affected by the  
percentage of  
image area,  
[ccc] Toner Not  
Installed  
[ccc] Toner is not  
installed.  
Remove seal tape &  
reinstall  
Group  
The machine cannot  
detect a toner cartridge.  
Remove the sealing  
tape from the toner  
cartridge.  
Refer to Quick Install  
Guide.  
quality cannot be  
guaranteed.  
You have tried to select a Use a speed dial  
group location number  
where only a single  
location number can be  
used, such as when  
adding locations for a  
multiple send operation.  
number or dial number  
manually using the  
number keypad.  
Not Available  
Replace the toner  
cartridge for the best  
print quality when this  
message appears.  
Using a cartridge  
beyond this stage  
can result in printing  
quality issues. (See  
Data Read Fail  
Check USB Memory  
Data Write Fail  
Check USB Memory  
Door is open.  
Time expired while  
reading date.  
Try again.  
operating  
environment,  
Storing to the USB  
memory failed.  
Check the available  
USB memory space.  
printing interval,  
media type and  
media size. Some  
amount of toner  
may remain in the  
cartridge even  
when red LED is  
turns on and the  
printer stops  
The door is not securely  
latched.  
Close the door until it  
locks into place.  
Samsung does  
not recommend  
using  
non-genuine  
Samsung toner  
cartridge such  
as refilled or  
remanufactured  
. Samsung  
cannot  
guarantee  
non-genuine  
Samsung toner  
cartridge's  
quality. Service  
or repair  
required as a  
result of using  
non-genuine  
Samsung toner  
cartridges will  
not be covered  
under the  
Close it  
Door is open or  
Check Transfer belt  
IP Conflict  
This IP address  
conflicts with that  
of other system  
Connection Error  
The front door is not  
securely latched.  
Close the front door  
until it locks into place.  
The IP address is used  
elsewhere.  
Check the IP address or  
obtain a new IP  
address.  
printing.  
Connection with the  
SMTP server failed.  
Check the server  
settings and the  
network cable.  
Enter Again  
You entered an  
unavailable item.  
Enter the correct item  
again.  
Fax memory is  
almost full  
The fax memory is full.  
Delete unnecessary fax  
jobs and retransmit after  
more memory becomes  
available. Alternatively,  
split the transmission  
into more than one  
operation.  
Fan error  
Error: [aaa]  
Turn off then on  
There is a problem in the Turn the machine off  
machine.  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
call for service.  
machine  
warranty.  
If the machine stops  
printing, replace the  
toner cartridge (See  
Fuser error  
Error: [aaa]  
Turn off then on  
There is a problem in the Turn the machine off  
machine.  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
call for service.  
Fuser unit Not  
Installed  
The fuser unit is not  
installed.  
Call for service.  
[ccc] toner Not  
Compatible  
[ccc] toner cartridge  
is not compatible.  
Check guide  
The toner cartridge you  
have installed is not for  
your machine.  
Install a  
Samsung-genuine toner  
cartridge, designed for  
your machine.  
Fuser unit is not  
installed.  
Install it  
Troubleshooting_ 9  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Paper Empty in  
[yyy]  
Paper is empty  
in [yyy].  
Load paper  
Jam bottom of  
duplex  
There is no paper in the  
tray.  
Load paper in the tray  
Network Error  
There is a problem  
with the network.  
There is a problem with  
the network.  
Check the network. If  
the problem persists,  
ask the system  
administrator or the  
person who has set up  
your local network.  
Try again. Verify the  
number to ensure that a  
fax can be received.  
Paper has jammed  
during duplex printing.  
Clear the jam (See "In  
page 7).  
No Answer  
The remote fax machine  
has not answered after  
several redial attempts.  
The remote fax  
machine has not  
answered  
Not proper room  
temperature.  
Change room  
temperature  
Jam in exit area  
Paper has jammed in exit Clear the jam (See "In  
area.  
The machine is in a room Move the machine to a  
with improper room  
temperature.  
Jam inside machine Paper has jammed  
Clear the jam (See  
page 4).  
Clear the jam (See "In  
page 7).  
Clear the jam (See "In  
page 7).  
The received fax data  
will be deleted.  
Reconfirm junk fax  
setup (See "Receiving"  
Try again after a few  
minutes.  
room with proper room  
temperature (See  
"Environmental  
page 1).  
Check the display to  
see if there are any  
scheduled jobs. The  
display should indicate  
if any scheduled jobs  
are in Standby mode,  
for example, Delay Fax.  
Connect the machine to  
the network with a  
network cable.  
inside the machine.  
Jam inside of  
duplex  
Paper has jammed  
during duplex printing.  
No Such Job  
You are performing an  
Add Pages or Cancel  
Job operation, but there  
are no jobs waiting.  
Jam top of duplex  
Paper has jammed  
during duplex printing.  
Junk Fax Error  
Junk Fax Job  
Cancelled  
The machine has  
received a fax from  
which is registered as a  
junk fax.  
Network problem  
Network cable is  
not connected.  
Check it.  
Network problem  
Network card is  
not installed.  
Check it.  
Original paper Jam  
Original paper Jam  
inside of scanner.  
Remove Jam  
The machine is not  
connected with a  
network cable.  
Line Busy  
The line is already  
engaged.  
Try Again Later  
Line Error  
The Fax Line has a  
problem.  
Try Again Later  
The receiving fax  
machine did not answer  
or the line is already  
engaged.  
There is a problem on  
the network interface.  
Turn the power switch  
off and on. If the  
problem persists, call  
for service.  
Your machine cannot  
connect with the  
receiving fax machine or so for the line to clear  
has lost contact because again. Or, turn the ECM  
of a problem with the  
phone line.  
There is a problem in the Turn the machine off  
Try again. If the problem  
persists, wait an hour or  
The load original has  
jammed in the document "Clearing original  
feeder.  
Clear the jam (See  
mode on (See  
page 2).  
LSU error  
machine.  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
call for service.  
Press the left/right  
arrow to highlight  
Cancel or Start, then  
press OK. If you select  
Cancel , the machine  
stops the fax job. If you  
select Start, the  
machine only sends  
scanned documents of  
the fax job.  
Split the transmission  
into more than one  
operation.  
Print or remove the  
received fax data in the  
memory.  
Original paper Jam  
Original paper is too  
long for scanner.  
Check size  
Output Bin Full  
Output Bin Full  
Remove printed  
paper  
The original is too long  
for scanner.  
Check the originals  
Error: [aaa]  
Turn off then on  
Memory Full  
Cancel | Start  
The memory is full.  
The document output  
tray is full.  
The document output  
tray can hold up to 160  
sheets of plain paper.  
Once the paper is  
removed from the  
document output tray,  
the printer resumes  
printing.  
Paper Jam in MP  
Paper has jammed in the Clear the jam (See "In  
multi-purpose tray area.  
Memory Full  
Divide the job  
The memory is full.  
The memory is full.  
Paper Jam in tray1  
Paper Jam in tray2  
Paper has jammed in the Clear the jam (See "In  
tray1 area. tray 1" on page 3).  
Paper has jammed in the Clear the jam (See "In  
Memory Full  
Fax memory is full.  
Print or remove  
received fax job  
tray2 area.  
page 3).  
Motor Error  
There is a problem in the Turn the machine off  
machine.  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
call for service.  
Error: [aaa]  
Turn off then on  
Troubleshooting_ 10  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Paper Empty in  
[yyy]  
Paper is empty in  
[yyy]  
Load paper  
Paper Mismatch  
[yyy]  
There is no paper in  
the tray.  
Load paper in the tray  
Self Diagnostics  
Please Wait...  
The engine in your  
printer is performing self  
diagnostics.  
There is a problem in  
DNS.  
Please wait a few  
minutes.  
Send Error  
There is a problem  
in DNS  
Send Error  
There is a problem  
in POP3  
Send Error  
There is a problem  
in SMTP  
Send Error  
There is a problem  
in SMTP  
Configure the DNS  
setting.  
The paper size  
You can select the  
option between  
specified in the printer  
properties does not  
match the paper you  
are loading.  
There is a problem in  
POP3.  
Configure the POP3  
setting.  
Continue or Cancel. If  
you select Cancel , the  
printing job will stop.  
Load the correct paper  
in the tray. If you select  
Continue, printing job  
will continue.  
Check your network  
environment, or contact  
your network  
Load [zzz][xxx]  
Continue  
Cancel  
There is a problem in  
SMTP.  
Change to the available  
server.  
There is a problem in  
SMTP authentication.  
Configure the  
authentication setting.  
BOOTP problem  
BOOTP has a  
problem. Switching  
to Auto IP  
DHCP problem  
DHCP has a  
problem.  
Reconfigure  
BOOTP/static IP  
DHCP problem  
DHCP has a  
problem. Switching  
to Auto IP  
There is a problem with  
the network.  
authentication  
Send Error  
There is a problem  
on the NIC Card  
There is a problem on  
network interface card.  
Turn the power switch  
off and on. If the  
problem persists, call  
for service.  
administrator.  
There is a problem with  
the network.  
Check your network  
environment, or contact  
your network  
Sensor Failure  
[aaa]  
Turn off then on  
There is a problem in the Turn the machine off  
sensor signal.  
administrator.  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
call for service.  
Divide your mail or  
reduce the resolution.  
There is a problem with  
the network.  
Check your network  
environment, or contact  
your network  
Mail Size Error  
Mail exceeds than  
server support  
The mail size is larger  
than the supported size  
by SMTP server.  
administrator.  
BOOTP problem  
BOOTP has a  
problem.  
There is a problem with  
the network.  
Check your network  
environment, or contact  
your network  
System error  
Error: [aaa]  
Turn off then on  
There is a problem in the Turn the machine off  
machine.  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
call for service.  
administrator.  
Reconfigure  
DHCP/static IP  
Mail Size Error  
One Page is  
Too Large  
Too many Faxes  
Too may faxes are  
received. Print or  
remove job  
Too many Faxes  
Too may faxes are  
queued. Wait or  
remove job  
Single page data  
exceeds the configured  
mail size.  
Reduce the resolution  
and try again.  
Replace [ccc] toner  
Replace with new  
[ccc] Toner  
The toner cartridge has  
reached the end of its  
lifespan.  
Replace the toner  
cartridge with a  
Samsung-genuine toner  
cartridge (See  
This message appears  
when the fuser unit is  
worn. Replace the fuser  
unit with a new one. Call  
for service.  
Too many faxes are  
received.  
Print or remove  
received fax.  
Replace Fuser unit  
Replace with new  
fuser unit  
The fuser unit has  
reached the end of its  
lifespan.  
Too many faxes are  
queued to be sent.  
Cancel reserved fax in  
priority fax feature.  
TR belt Not installed The transfer belt is not  
Install a  
Samsung-genuine  
transfer belt.  
Retry Redial?  
The machine is  
waiting for a specified  
time interval to redial  
a previously busy  
station.  
You can press OK to  
immediately redial,  
Stop/Clear to cancel  
the redial operation.  
installed.  
Transfer belt unit is  
not installed.  
Install it  
TR. belt Not  
compatible  
Transfer belt unit is  
not compatible.  
Check guide  
Transfer belt is low  
Transfer belt unit  
will be worn.  
The transfer belt of the  
machine is not for your  
machine.  
Install the a  
Samsung-genuine part  
designed for your  
machine.  
Scanner door Open  
Door of scanner is  
open.  
The scanner door is not  
securely latched.  
Close the scanner door  
until it locks into place.  
Close it  
The life of the transfer  
belt will expired soon.  
Order a transfer belt  
page 2).  
Scanner locked  
Scanner locking  
switch is locked.  
Release it  
The scanner module is  
locked.  
Unlock the CCD (See  
Or turn off the machine  
and on again. If the  
problem persists, call  
for service.  
Order new one  
Troubleshooting_ 11  
Solving other problems  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Replace TR. Belt  
Replace with new  
Transfer belt unit  
The life of the transfer  
belt has expired.  
Replace the transfer  
belt with a new one.  
Install a  
The following chart lists some conditions that may occur and the  
recommended solutions. Follow the suggested solutions until the problem is  
corrected. If the problem persists, call for service.  
Samsung-genuine  
transfer belt.  
Power problems  
Tray[yyy] cassette  
Out  
The tray is not properly  
closed.  
To close the tray, lower  
the rear edge, align it  
with the slot, and slide it  
into the printer.  
Tray[yyy] cassette  
is pulled out.  
Insert it properly  
Tray[yyy] has a  
problem  
Communication  
problem occurred  
with tray[yyy]  
The machine cannot  
communicate with the  
optional tray .  
Reinstall the optional  
tray. If the problem  
persists, call for service.  
Tray[yyy] Not  
Installed  
Tray[yyy] is not  
installed. Install it  
The optional tray is not  
installed.  
Reinstall the optional  
tray. If the problem  
persists, call for service.  
Tray2 has a problem The machine cannot  
Check the cable  
communicate with the  
optional tray 2.  
connecting the machine  
and the optional tray 2.  
If the problem persists,  
call for service.  
Communication  
problem occurred  
with Tray2  
Tray2 Not installed  
Tray2 is not  
installed. Install it  
The optional tray2 is not  
installed.  
Install the optional tray  
2. If the optional tray 2 is  
installed, check the  
cable connecting the  
machine and the  
optional tray 2. If the  
problem persists, call  
for service.  
Updating Data  
Please Wait...  
The machine is  
updating data.  
Wait a few minutes.  
This message can  
also appear when  
printing on paper  
smaller than A4, such  
as envelope or B5. In  
this case, the machine  
is adjusting the  
settings for best print  
results.  
Troubleshooting_ 12  
 
Paper feeding problems  
Condition  
Suggested solutions  
Condition  
Suggested solutions  
The machine is  
not receiving  
power;  
Plug in the power cord and then press the power  
switch to turn the machine on.  
Paper jams during  
printing.  
Clear the paper jam (See "Clearing paper jams"  
or the printer  
cable connection  
between the  
computer and the  
machine is not  
connected  
Paper sticks  
together.  
Check the maximum paper capacity of the  
page 3).  
Make sure that you are using the correct type  
page 3).  
properly.  
Remove paper from the tray and flex or fan  
the paper.  
Humid conditions may cause some paper to  
stick together, install paper from a fresh ream.  
Or press  
(power) on the control panel.  
Multiple sheets of  
paper do not feed.  
Different types of paper may be stacked in the  
tray. Load paper of only one type, size, and  
weight.  
Paper does not feed  
into the machine.  
Remove any obstructions from inside the  
machine.  
Paper has not been loaded correctly. Remove  
paper from the tray and reload it correctly.  
There is too much paper in the tray. Remove  
excess paper from the tray.  
The paper is too thick. Use only paper that  
meets the specifications required by the  
page 3).  
Disconnect the machine printer cable and  
reconnect it.  
-For Local USB  
If an original does not feed into the machine,  
the document feeder rubber pad may require  
to be replaced. Contact a service  
representative.  
The paper keeps  
jamming.  
There is too much paper in the tray. Remove  
excess paper from the tray. If you are printing  
on special materials, use the multi-purpose  
tray.  
An incorrect type of paper is being used. Use  
only paper that meets the specifications  
required by the machine (See "Print media  
-For Network Printing  
There may be debris inside the machine.  
Open the front door and remove any debris.  
If an original does not feed into the machine,  
the document feeder rubber pad may need to  
be replaced. Contact a service representative.  
Envelopes skew or  
Ensure that the paper guides are against both  
fail to feed correctly. sides of the envelopes.  
Troubleshooting_ 13  
Printing problems  
Condition  
Possible cause  
Suggested solutions  
The machine  
does not print.  
The machine is not  
receiving power.  
Check the power cord  
connections. Check both  
power switches and the  
power source.  
The machine is not  
selected from the  
available printers  
list.  
Select this printers “Name”  
from the available printers  
drop-down list in the  
application you are printing  
from  
Check the machine for the following:  
The front door is not closed. Close the front  
door.  
Paper is jammed. Clear the paper jam (See  
No paper is loaded. Load paper (See "Loading  
The toner cartridge is not installed. Install the  
toner cartridge.  
If a system error occurs, contact your service  
representative.  
The connection  
printer cable  
between the  
Disconnect the machine  
printer cable and reconnect  
it.  
computer and the  
machine is not  
connected properly.  
The connection  
printer cable  
between the  
computer and the  
machine is  
If possible, attach the printer  
cable to another computer  
that is working properly and  
print a job. You can also try  
using a different machine  
printer cable.  
defective.  
The port setting is  
incorrect.  
Check the Windows printer  
settings to make sure that  
the print job is sent to the  
correct port. If the computer  
has more than one port,  
make sure that the machine  
is attached to the correct  
one.  
The machine may  
be configured  
incorrectly.  
Check the Printing  
Preferences to ensure that  
all of the print settings are  
correct (See "Opening  
page 2).  
The printer driver  
may be incorrectly  
installed.  
Repair the machine software  
The machine is  
malfunctioning.  
Check the display message  
on the control panel to see if  
the machine is indicating a  
system error. Contact a  
service representative.  
Troubleshooting_ 14  
Condition  
Possible cause  
Suggested solutions  
Condition  
Possible cause  
Suggested solutions  
The document size  
is so big that the  
hard disk space of  
the computer is  
insufficient to  
access the print job.  
Make available more hard  
disk space and print the  
document again.  
The machine  
prints, but the  
text is wrong,  
garbled, or  
The machine cable  
is loose or  
defective.  
Disconnect the machine  
printer cable and reconnect.  
Try a print job that you have  
already printed successfully.  
If possible, attach the printer  
cable and the machine to  
another computer that you  
know works ensure print  
driver is installed and try a  
print job. Finally, try a new  
machine printer cable.  
incomplete.  
The machine  
selects print  
materials from  
the wrong paper  
source.  
The paper option  
that was selected in applications, the paper  
the Printing  
Preferences may  
be incorrect.  
For many software  
source selection is found  
under the Paper tab within  
the Printing Preferences.  
Select the correct paper  
source. See the printer  
driver help screen (See  
The wrong printer  
Check the application’s  
driver was selected. printer selection menu to  
ensure that your machine is  
selected.  
The software  
application is  
malfunctioning.  
Try printing a job from  
another application.  
A print job is  
extremely slow.  
The job may be  
very complex.  
Reduce the complexity of  
the page or try adjusting the  
print quality settings.  
The operating  
system is  
malfunctioning.  
Exit Windows and reboot the  
computer. Turn the machine  
off and back on again.  
Half the page is  
blank.  
The page  
orientation setting  
may be incorrect.  
Change the page orientation  
in your application. See the  
printer driver help screen.  
If you are in a DOS Change the language  
environment, the setting (See "Changing the  
font setting for your display language" on  
machine may be  
set incorrectly.  
The paper size and Ensure that the paper size in  
the paper size  
settings do not  
match.  
the printer driver settings  
matches the paper in the  
tray.  
page 1).  
Or, ensure that the paper  
size in the printer driver  
settings matches the paper  
selection in the software  
application settings you use.  
Printer driver  
corrupted.  
Reinstall printer drvier.  
Pages print, but  
they are blank.  
The toner cartridge  
is defective or out of necessary.  
Redistribute the toner, if  
toner.  
If necessary, replace the  
toner cartridge.  
The file may have  
blank pages.  
Check the file to ensure that  
it does not contain blank  
pages.  
Some parts, such  
as the controller or  
the board, may be  
defective.  
Contact a service  
representative.  
The machine  
does not print  
PDF files  
correctly. Some  
parts of graphics,  
text, or  
Incompatibility  
between the PDF  
file and the Acrobat print. Turn on Print As  
products.  
Printing the PDF file as an  
image may enable the file to  
Image from the Acrobat  
printing options.  
It will take longer to  
print when you print a  
PDF file as an image.  
illustrations are  
missing.  
Troubleshooting_ 15  
Condition  
Possible cause  
Suggested solutions  
Condition  
Dropouts  
Suggested Solutions  
The print quality  
of photos is not  
good. Images are low.  
The resolution of  
the photo is very  
Reduce the photo size. If  
you increase the photo size  
in the software application,  
the resolution will be  
reduced.  
If faded areas, generally rounded, occur  
randomly on the page:  
A single sheet of paper may be defective.  
Try reprinting the job.  
The moisture content of the paper is uneven  
or the paper has moist spots on its surface.  
Try a different brand of paper (See "Print  
not clear.  
Before printing,  
the machine  
emits vapor near  
Using damp paper  
can cause vapor  
during printing.  
This is not a problem. Just  
keep printing.  
the output tray.  
The paper lot is bad. The manufacturing  
processes can cause some areas to reject  
toner. Try a different kind or brand of paper.  
Change the printer option and try again. Go  
to Printing Preferences, click Paper tab,  
and set type to Thick (See "Opening printing  
The machine  
does not print  
special- sized  
paper, such as  
billing paper.  
Paper size and  
paper size setting  
do not match.  
Set the correct paper size in  
the Paper tab in the  
Printing Preferences (See  
If these steps do not correct the problem,  
contact a service representative.  
Printing quality problems  
If the inside of the machine is dirty or paper has been loaded improperly,  
there might be a reduction in print quality. See the table below to clear the  
problem.  
White Spots  
If white spots appear on the page:  
The paper is too rough and a lot of dirt from a  
paper falls to the inner devices within the  
machine, so the transfer roller may be dirty.  
Clean the inside of your machine (See  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Light or faded print  
If a vertical white streak or faded area  
appears on the page, the toner supply is low.  
You may be able to temporarily extend the  
toner cartridge life (See"Redistributing toner"  
on page 1). If this does not improve the print  
quality, install a new toner cartridge.  
The paper may not meet paper specifications;  
for example, the paper may be too moist or  
page 3).  
If the entire page is light, the print resolution  
setting is too low or the toner save mode is  
on. Adjust the print resolution and turn the  
toner save mode off. See the help screen of  
the printer driver.  
A combination of faded or smeared defects  
may indicate that the toner cartridge needs  
page 2).  
The paper path may need cleaning (See  
Vertical lines  
If black vertical streaks appear on the page:  
The surface (drum part) of the toner  
cartridge inside the machine has probably  
been scratched. Remove the toner cartridge  
and install a new one (See "Replacing the  
If white vertical streaks appear on the page:  
The surface of the LSU part inside the  
machine may be dirty (See "Cleaning the  
If vertical streaks appear on the page:  
The surface of the scanner glass and its  
white sheet may be dirty. Clean these unit  
The surface of the LSU part inside the  
machine may be dirty (See "Cleaning the  
Color or Black  
background  
If the amount of background shading becomes  
unacceptable:  
Change to a lighter weight paper (See "Print  
Check the environmental conditions: very  
dry conditions or a high level of humidity  
(higher than 80% RH) can increase the  
amount of background shading.  
Remove the old toner cartridge and, install a  
cartridge" on page 2). If this problem  
Toner specks  
The paper may not meet specifications; for  
example, the paper may be too moist or rough  
The transfer roller may be dirty. Clean the  
inside of your machine. Contact a service  
representative.  
The paper path may need cleaning. Contact a  
service representative.  
persists, contact a service representative.  
Troubleshooting_ 16  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
If toner smears on the page:  
Condition  
Page skew  
Suggested Solutions  
Toner smear  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality (See "Print  
Ensure that the guides are not too tight or too  
loose against the paper stack.  
Clean the inside of the machine (See  
Check the paper type and quality (See "Print  
Remove the toner cartridge and then, install  
Vertical repetitive  
defects  
If marks repeatedly appear on the printed side of  
the page at even intervals:  
Curl or wave  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality. Both high  
temperature and humidity can cause paper  
page 3).  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also  
try rotating the paper 180° in the tray.  
The toner cartridge may be damaged. If you  
still have the same problem, remove the  
toner cartridge and, install a new one (See  
Parts of the machine may have toner on  
them. If the defects occur on the back of the  
page, the problem will likely correct itself  
after a few more pages.  
The fusing assembly may be damaged.  
Contact a service representative.  
Wrinkles or  
creases  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality (See "Print  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also  
try rotating the paper 180° in the tray.  
Background  
scatter  
Background scatter results from bits of toner  
randomly distributed on the printed page.  
The paper may be too damp. Try printing  
with a fresh ream of paper. Do not open  
reams of paper until necessary so that the  
paper does not absorb too much moisture.  
If background scatter occurs on an envelope,  
change the printing layout to avoid printing  
over areas that have overlapping seams on  
the reverse side. Printing on seams can  
cause problems.  
A
Back of printouts  
are dirty  
Check for leaking toner. Clean the inside of the  
If background scatter covers the entire  
surface area of a printed page, adjust the  
print resolution through your software  
application or in Printing Preferences (See  
Misformed  
characters  
If characters are improperly formed and  
producing hollow images, the paper stock  
may be too slick. Try different paper (See  
If characters are improperly formed and  
producing a wavy effect, the scanner unit may  
page 3).  
Solid Color or  
Black pages  
The toner cartridge may not be installed  
properly. Remove the cartridge and reinsert it.  
The toner cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the toner cartridge and install a new  
page 2).  
The machine may require repair. Contact a  
service representative.  
Troubleshooting_ 17  
Copying problems  
Condition  
Loose toner  
Suggested Solutions  
Condition  
Suggested solution  
Clean the inside of the machine (See  
Check the paper type and quality (See "Print  
Remove the toner cartridge and then, install a  
If the problem persists, the machine may  
require repair. Contact a service  
representative.  
Copies are too light  
or too dark  
Use Darkness in Copy feature to lighten or  
darken the backgrounds of copies (See  
Smears, lines,  
If the defects are on the original, use  
Darkness in Copy feature to lighten the  
background of your copies (See "Changing  
marks, or spots  
appear on copies.  
If there are no defects on the original, clean  
page 3).  
Character Voids  
Character voids are white areas within parts of  
characters that should be solid black:  
Copy image is  
skewed.  
Ensure that the original is face down on the  
scanner glass or face up in the document  
feeder.  
You may be printing on the wrong surface of  
the paper. Remove the paper and turn it  
around.  
Check that the copy paper is loaded correctly.  
The paper may not meet paper  
specifications (See "Print media  
Blank copies print  
out.  
Ensure that the original is face down on the  
scanner glass or face up in the document  
feeder.  
A
Image rubs off the  
copy easily.  
Replace the paper in the tray with paper from  
a new package.  
In high humidity areas, do not leave paper in  
the machine for extended periods of time.  
Horizontal stripes  
If horizontally aligned black streaks, white  
streaks or smears appear:  
The toner cartridge may be installed  
improperly. Remove the cartridge and  
reinsert it.  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
Frequent copy paper  
jams occur.  
Fan the paper, then turn it over in the tray.  
Replace the paper in the tray with a fresh  
supply. Check/adjust the paper guides, if  
necessary.  
Ensure that the paper is the proper type and  
weight.  
Check for copy paper or pieces of copy paper  
remaining in the machine after a paper jam  
has been cleared.  
The toner cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the toner cartridge and install a new  
page 2).  
The machine might had a minor shock  
during printing or copying. There is no  
problem with the machine. Try printing again.  
If the problem persists, the machine may  
require repair. Contact a service  
representative.  
Toner cartridge  
produces fewer  
copies than  
expected before  
running out of toner.  
Your originals may contain pictures, solids, or  
heavy lines. For example, your originals may  
be forms, newsletters, books, or other  
documents that use more toner.  
The scanner lid may be left open while copies  
are being made.  
Curl  
If the printed paper is curled or paper does not  
feed into the machine:  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also  
try rotating the paper 180° in the tray.  
Turn the machine off and back on.  
Change the printer option and try again. Go  
to Printing Preferences, click Paper tab,  
and set type to Thin (See "Opening printing  
An unknown image Your machine is probably being used at an  
repetitively  
altitude of 1,000 m (3,281 ft) or above.  
The high altitude may affect the print quality,  
such as loose toner or light imaging. Change the  
correct altitude setting to your machine (See  
appears on a few  
sheets or loose  
toner, light print, or  
contamination  
occurs.  
Troubleshooting_ 18  
Scanning problems  
Fax problems  
Condition  
Suggested solutions  
condition  
suggested solutions  
The scanner does not  
work.  
Make sure that you place the original to be  
scanned face down on the scanner glass, or  
face up in the document feeder.  
There may not be enough available memory  
to hold the document you want to scan. Try  
the Prescan function to see if that works.  
Try lowering the scan resolution rate.  
Check that the machine printer cable is  
connected properly.  
Make sure that the machine printer cable is  
not defective. Switch the printer cable with a  
known good cable. If necessary, replace the  
printer cable.  
The machine is not  
working, there is no  
display, or the  
buttons are not  
working.  
Unplug the power cord and plug it in again.  
Ensure that there is power being supplied to the  
electrical outlet.  
Ensure that the power switch is turned on, and  
the soft power switch on the control panel is  
pressed.  
No dial tone.  
Check that the phone line is properly  
connected.  
Check that the phone socket on the wall is  
working by plugging in another phone.  
The numbers stored Make sure that the numbers are stored in memory  
in memory do not  
correctly. Print a Addess Book list (See "Setting  
Check that the scanner is configured  
correctly. Check scan setting in the  
SmarThru Office or the application you want  
to use to make certain that the scanner job  
is being sent to the correct port (for example,  
USB001).  
dial correctly.  
The original does  
not feed into the  
machine.  
Make sure that the paper is not wrinkled and  
you are inserting it in correctly. Check that the  
original is the right size, not too thick or thin.  
Make sure that the document feeder is firmly  
closed.  
The document feeder rubber pad may need to  
be replaced. Contact a service representative.  
The unit scans very  
slowly.  
Check if the machine is printing received  
data. If so, scan the document after the  
received data has been printed.  
Faxes are not  
received  
automatically.  
The receiving mode should be set to fax.  
Make sure that there is paper in the tray.  
Check to see if the display shows any error  
message. If it does, clear the problem  
Graphics are scanned more slowly than text.  
Communication speed slows in scan mode  
because of the large amount of memory  
required to analyze and reproduce the  
scanned image. Set your computer to the  
ECP printer mode through BIOS setting. It  
will help to increase the speed. For details  
about how to set BIOS, refer to your  
computer user’s guide.  
The machine does  
not send.  
Make sure that the original is loaded in the  
document feeder or on the scanner glass.  
Check the fax machine you are sending to, to  
see if it can receive your fax.  
The incoming fax  
has blank spaces or  
is of poor-quality.  
The fax machine sending you the fax may be  
faulty.  
A noisy phone line can cause line errors.  
Check your machine by making a copy.  
A toner cartridge has almost reached its  
estimated cartridge life. Replace the toner  
Message appears on  
your computer  
screen:  
There may be a copying or printing job in  
progress. Try your job again when that job is  
finished.  
The selected port is currently being used.  
Restart your computer and try again.  
The machine printer cable may be  
improperly connected or the power may be  
off.  
Device can’t be  
set to the H/W  
mode you want.  
Port is being used  
by another  
program.  
Port is Disabled.  
The scanner driver is not installed or the  
operating environment is not set up properly.  
Some of the words  
on an incoming fax  
are stretched.  
The fax machine sending the fax had a temporary  
document jam.  
Scanner is busy  
receiving or  
printing data.  
When the current  
job is completed.,  
try again.  
Ensure that the machine is properly  
connected and the power is on, then restart  
your computer.  
The USB cable may be improperly  
connected or the power may be off.  
There are lines on  
the originals you  
sent.  
Check your scan unit for marks and clean it (See  
Invalid handle.  
Scanning has  
failed.  
Troubleshooting_ 19  
condition  
suggested solutions  
Problem  
Possible cause  
Solution  
The machine dials a  
number, but the  
connection with the  
other fax machine  
fails.  
The other fax machine may be turned off, out of  
paper, or cannot answer incoming calls. Speak  
with the other machine operator and ask them to  
solve the problem on their side.  
PostScript file  
cannot be printed.  
The PostScript  
driver may not be  
installed correctly.  
Install the PostScript  
driver (See "Installing  
USB connected  
page 3).  
Faxes do not store in There may not be enough memory space to store  
Print a configuration  
page and verify that  
the PS version is  
available for printing.  
Reinstall the PS  
memory.  
the fax. If the display indicating the memory status  
shows, delete any faxes you no longer need from  
the memory, and then try to store the fax again.  
Call for service.  
driver. If the problem  
persists, contact a  
service representative.  
Blank areas appear  
at the bottom of  
each page or on  
other pages, with a  
small strip of text at  
the top  
You may have chosen the wrong paper settings in  
the user option setting. For details about paper  
page 7).  
“Limit Check Error”  
report prints.  
The print job was  
too complex.  
You might need to  
reduce the complexity of  
the page or install more  
memory (See "Installing  
page 5).  
Samsung Scan and Fax Manager Problem  
Condition  
suggested solution  
A PostScript error  
page prints.  
The print job may  
not be PostScript.  
Make sure that the print  
job is a PostScript job.  
Check to see whether  
the software application  
expected a setup or  
PostScript header file to  
be sent to the machine.  
Samsung Scan and  
Fax Manager does  
not work.  
Check your system requirements. Samsung  
Scan and Fax Manager works in Window and  
page 2).  
Check that the Samsung Scan and Fax  
Manager is installed by looking under “All  
programs” in windows. If not installed and/or  
working correctly, reinstalled using the CD  
supplied with the product, or download the  
latest version from the Samsung website.  
(www.samsung.com/printer)  
The optional tray is  
not selected in the  
driver.  
The printer driver  
has not been  
configured to  
recognize the  
optional tray.  
Open the PostScript  
driver properties, select  
the Device Options tab,  
and set the tray option.  
When printing a  
document in  
Macintosh with  
Acrobat Reader 6.0  
or higher, colors  
print incorrectly.  
The resolution  
setting in the printer resolution setting in your  
driver may not be  
matched with the  
one in Acrobat  
Reader.  
Make sure that the  
Common PostScript problems  
The following situations are PS language specific and may occur when  
several printer languages are used.  
printer driver matches  
the one in Acrobat  
Reader.  
Common Windows problems  
Condition  
Suggested solutions  
“File in Use”  
message appears  
during installation.  
Exit all software applications. Remove all  
software from the printer’s startup group, then  
restart Windows. Reinstall the printer driver.  
“General Protection  
Fault”, “Exception  
OE”, “Spool 32”, or  
“Illegal Operation”  
messages appear.  
Close all other applications, reboot Windows  
and try printing again.  
“Fail To Print”, “A  
These messages may appear during printing.  
printer timeout error Just keep waiting until the machine finishes  
occurred” messages printing. If the message appears in standby  
appear.  
mode or after printing has been completed,  
check the connection and/or whether an error  
has occurred.  
Troubleshooting_ 20  
Refer to Microsoft Windows User’s Guide that came with your  
computer for further information on Windows error messages.  
condition  
Suggested solutions  
Some color images  
come out all black.  
This is a known bug in Ghostscript (until GNU  
Ghostscript version 7.05) when the base color  
space of the document is indexed color space  
and it is converted through CIE color space.  
Because Postscript uses CIE color space for  
Color Matching System, you should upgrade  
Ghostscript on your system to at least GNU  
Ghostscript version 7.06 or later. You can find  
recent Ghostscript versions at  
Common Linux problems  
condition  
Suggested solutions  
The machine does  
not print.  
Check if the printer driver is installed in your  
system. Open Unified Driver Configurator and  
switch to the Printers tab in Printers  
configuration window to look at the list of  
available machines. Make sure that your  
machine is displayed on the list. If not, open  
Add new printer wizard to set up your  
device.  
www.ghostscript.com.  
Some color images  
come out in  
unexpected color.  
This is a known bug in Ghostscript (until GNU  
Ghostscript version 7.xx) when the base color  
space of the document is indexed RGB color  
space and it is converted through CIE color  
space. Because Postscript uses CIE color space  
for Color Matching System, you should upgrade  
Ghostscript on your system to at least GNU  
Ghostscript version 8.xx or later. You can find  
recent Ghostscript versions at  
Check if the machine is started. Open  
Printers configuration and select your  
machine on the printers list. Look at the  
description in the Selected printer pane. If its  
status contains Stopped string, press the  
Start button. After that normal operation of  
the machine should be restored. The  
“stopped” status might be activated when  
some problems in printing occurred. For  
instance, this could be an attempt to print a  
document when the port is claimed by a  
scanning application.  
www.ghostscript.com.  
The machine does  
not print whole  
pages and its output Ghostscript, 64-bit Linux OS, and reported to  
It is a known problem that occurs when a color  
printer is used on version 8.51 or earlier of  
is half page printed.  
bugs.ghostscript.com as Ghostscript Bug  
688252.  
The problem is solved in AFPL Ghostscript v.  
8.52 or above. Download the latest version of  
AFPL Ghostscript from  
Ensure the port is not busy. Since functional  
components of machine (printer and scanner)  
share the same I/O interface (port), the  
situation of simultaneous access of different  
user applications to the same port is possible.  
To avoid possible conflicts, only one of them  
at a time is allowed to gain control over the  
device. The other user will encounter “device  
busy” response. You should open ports  
configuration and select the port assigned to  
your machine. In the Selected port pane you  
can see if the port is occupied by some other  
application. If this is the case, you should  
either wait for completion of the current job or  
press the Release port button, if you are sure  
that the present application is not functioning  
properly.  
http://sourceforge.net/projects/gho  
I cannot scan via  
Gimp Front-end.  
Check if Gimp Front-end has Xsane:Device  
dialog. on the Acquire menu. If not, you should  
install Xsane plug-in for Gimp on the your  
computer. You can find Xsane plug-in package  
for Gimp on Linux distribution CD or Gimp home  
page. For the detailed information, refer to the  
Help for Linux distribution CD or Gimp Front-end  
application.  
If you wish to use another kind of scan  
application, refer to application’s Help.  
I encounter error  
“Cannot open port  
device file” when  
Avoid changing print job parameters (via LPR  
GUI, for example) while a print job is in progress.  
Known versions of CUPS (Common UNIX  
Check if your application has special print  
option such as “-oraw”. If “-oraw” is specified  
in the command line parameter, then remove  
it to print properly. For Gimp front-end, select  
“print” -> “Setup printer” and edit command  
line parameter in the command item.  
The CUPS (Common UNIXPrinting System)  
version distributed with SuSE Linux 9.2  
(cups-1.1.21) has a problem with ipp (Internet  
Printing Protocol) printing.Use the socket  
printing instead of ipp or install a later version  
of CUPS (cups-1.1.22 or higher).  
printing a document. Printing System) server break the print job  
whenever print options are changed and then try  
to restart the job from the beginning. Since  
Unified Linux Driver locks the port while printing,  
the abrupt termination of the driver keeps the  
port locked and unavailable for subsequent print  
jobs. If this situation occurs, try to release the  
port by selecting Release port in Port  
configuration window.  
Troubleshooting_ 21  
Common Macintosh problems  
condition  
Suggested solutions  
condition  
Suggested solutions  
The machine does  
not appear on the  
scanners list.  
Ensure your machine is attached to your  
computer, connected properly via the USB  
port, and is turned on.  
Ensure the scanner driver for your machine is  
installed in your system. Open Unified Linux  
Driver configurator, switch to Scanners  
configuration, then press Drivers. Make  
sure that driver with a name corresponding to  
your machine's name is listed in the window.  
The machine does  
not print PDF files  
correctly. Some  
parts of graphics,  
text, or illustrations  
are missing.  
Printing the PDF file as an image may enable  
the file to print. Turn on Print As Image from the  
Acrobat printing options.  
It will take longer to print when you print a  
PDF file as an image.  
The document has  
Update your Mac OS to OS Mac OS X 10.3.3. or  
printed, but the print higher.  
job has not  
disappeared from  
the spooler in Mac  
OS X 10.3.2.  
Ensure the port is not busy. Since functional  
components of machine (printer and scanner)  
share the same I/O interface (port), the  
situation of simultaneous access of different  
user applications to the same port is possible.  
To avoid possible conflicts, only one of them  
at a time is allowed to gain control over the  
device. The other user will encounter “device  
busy” response. This usually happens when  
starting a scan procedure. An appropriate  
message box appears.  
To identify the source of the problem, open  
the Ports configuration and select the port  
assigned to your scanner, port's symbol  
/dev/mfp0 corresponds to LP:0 designation  
displayed in the scanners’ options, /dev/mfp1  
relates to LP:1, and so on. USB ports start at  
/dev/mfp4, so scanner on USB:0 relates to  
/dev/mfp4 respectively and so forth  
Some letters are not Mac OS cannot create the font during the cover  
displayed normally  
during the cover  
page printing.  
page printing. The English alphabet and  
numbers are displayed normally on the cover  
page.  
When printing a  
document in  
Macintosh with  
Acrobat Reader 6.0  
or higher, colors  
print incorrectly.  
Make sure that the resolution setting in your  
machine driver matches the one in Acrobat  
Reader.  
Refer to Macintosh User’s Guide that came with your computer for  
further information on Macintosh error messages.  
sequentially. In the Selected port pane, you  
can see if the port is occupied by another  
application. If this is the case, you should  
either wait for completion of the current job or  
press the Release port button, if you are sure  
that the present port applicaton is not  
functioning properly.  
The machine does  
not scan.  
Ensure a document is loaded into the  
machine, ensure your machine is connected  
to the computer.  
If there is an I/O error while scanning.  
Refer to Linux User’s Guide that came with your computer for further  
information on Linux error messages.  
Troubleshooting_ 22  
1.  
supplies and accessories  
This chapter provides information on purchasing supplies, accessories and maintenance parts available for your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
Available accessories may differ from country to country. Contact your  
sales representatives to obtain the list of available accessories.  
Average yielda  
Type  
TONER  
CARTRIDGES  
High yield  
Part name  
Average continuous  
black cartridge yield:  
5,000 standard pages  
(Black)  
K508L(CLT-K508L): Black  
C508L(CLT-C508L): Cyan  
M508L(CLT-M508L):  
Magenta  
Y508L(CLT-Y508L):  
Yellow  
Region Ab:  
How to purchase  
To order Genuine Samsung supplies, accessories and, maintenance parts,  
contact your local Samsung dealer or the authorized retailer where you  
Average continuous  
colored cartridge yield:  
4,000 standard pages  
(Yellow/Magenta/Cyan)  
K5082L(CLT-K5082L):  
Black  
Available supplies  
C5082L(CLT-C5082L):  
Cyan  
When supplies reach their lifespan, you can order the following types of  
supplies for your machine:  
M5082L(CLT-M5082L):  
Magenta  
Y5082L(CLT-Y5082L):  
Yellow  
Average yielda  
Type  
TONER  
CARTRIDGES  
Standard yield  
Part name  
Average continuous  
black cartridge yield:  
2,500 standard pages  
(Black)  
K508(CLT-K508S): Black  
C508(CLT-C508S): Cyan  
M508(CLT-M508S):  
Magenta  
Y508(CLT-Y508S): Yellow  
Region Ab:  
Paper transfer Approx. 50,000 pages  
CLT-T508  
belt  
When the transfer belt has  
worn out with abrasion,  
you need to change it. By  
this time you may be  
notified with the transfer  
belt-related message on  
the display.  
Average continuous  
colored cartridge yield:  
2,000 standard pages  
(Yellow/Magenta/Cyan)  
K5082(CLT-K5082S):  
Black  
C5082(CLT-C5082S):  
Cyan  
M5082(CLT-M5082S):  
Magenta  
Y5082(CLT-Y5082S):  
Yellow  
a.Declared yield value in accordance with ISO/IEC 19798.  
b.Region A: Albania, Austria, Belgium, Bosnia, Bulgaria, Croatia, Cyprus,  
Czech Republic, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, Greece,  
Hungary, Italy, Macedonia, Netherlands, Norway, Poland, Portugal,  
Romania, Serbia, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, UK.  
To replace a toner cartridge see "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 2.  
Depending on the options and percentage of image area, job mode  
used, the toner cartridge’s lifespan may differ.  
You must purchase supplies, including toner cartridges, in the same  
country where you purchased your machine. Otherwise, supplies will  
be incompatable with your machine since the system configurations  
vary from country to country.  
Supplies and accessories_ 1  
     
Available accessories  
a.It will be affected by operating system used, computing performance,  
application software, connecting method, media type, media size and  
job complexity.  
You can purchase and install accessories to enhance your machine’s  
performance and capacity.  
Accessory  
function  
Part name  
Replacing the toner cartridge  
Memory module  
Extend your machine’s  
memory capacity.  
CLX-6220 Series  
-CLP-MEM201: 128 MB  
-CLP-MEM202: 256 MB  
CLX-6250 Series  
-ML-MEM150: 128 MB  
-ML-MEM160: 256 MB  
-ML-MEM170: 512 MB  
When the toner cartridge reaches its estimated cartridge life.  
The status LED and the toner-related message on the display indicates  
which each individual toner cartridge should be replaced.  
The machine stops printing. Incoming faxes are saved in memory.  
At this stage, the toner cartridge needs to be replaced. Check the type of the  
toner cartridge for your machine (See "Available supplies" on page 1).  
Optional tray 2  
If you are experiencing CLX-S6250A  
frequent paper supply  
problems, you can  
1. Using the handle, completely open the front door.  
attach an additional 500  
sheets tray. You can  
print documents in  
various sizes and types  
of print materials.  
Hard disk  
(CLX-6250 Series  
only)  
Allows you to enhance ML-HDK300  
the machine’s capability  
and print in various  
ways.  
IEEE 802.11 b/g  
Wireless LAN  
(CLX-6250 Series  
only)a  
Allows you to connect  
your printer to a  
wireless network.  
ML-NWA40L  
a.Depending on your country, wireless LAN cards may not be available.  
Contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you bought your  
printer.  
2. Grasp the handles on the toner cartridge and pull to remove the  
cartridge from the machine.  
Maintenance parts  
To purchase maintenance parts, contact the source where you bought the  
machine.  
Replacing maintenance parts can be performed only by an authorized  
service provider, dealer, or the retailer where you bought the machine. The  
warranty does not cover the replacement of any maintenance parts once it  
has reached its “Average Yield”.  
Maintenance parts are replaced at specific intervals to avoid print quality  
and paper feed problems resulting from worn parts, see table below. The  
purpose of which is to maintain your machine in top working condition. The  
maintenance parts below should be replaced when the life span of each  
item has been met.  
Average yielda  
parts  
Fuser unit  
Approx. 100,000 pages  
Approx. 75,000 pages  
Approx. 20,000 pages  
If you open the front door, be careful not to touch the underneath  
the control panel (the lower part of the fuser unit). The temperature  
of the fuser unit might be extremely hot and could damage your  
Document feeder friction pad  
Document feeder pick-up roller  
Pick-up roller (Multi-purpose tray, Tray1, Approx. 70,000 pages  
Optional tray 2)  
Friction pad (Multi-purpose tray, Tray1,  
Optional tray 2)  
Approx. 70,000 pages  
Supplies and accessories_ 2  
         
skin.  
place completely.  
When you open the front door and work inside the machine, it is  
highly recommend that you remove the paper transfer belt first.  
Because the work you do could contaminate the paper transfer  
belt.  
3. Remove the new toner cartridge from its bag.  
7. Close the front door. Make sure that the cover is securely closed.  
Don't use sharp objects, such as a knife or scissors, to open the  
print cartridge package. You could damage the surface of the  
print cartridge.  
If the front door is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
To prevent damage, do not expose the print cartridge to light for  
more than a few minutes. Cover it with a piece of paper to  
protect it if necessary.  
Replacing the paper transfer belt  
4. Slowly shake the cartridge five or six times to distribute the toner evenly  
After the life span of the paper transfer belt is complete, you have to replace  
it.  
inside the cartridge. It will assure maximum copies per cartridge.  
The transfer belt-related message appears on the display, telling it's  
time for a replacement.  
The Smart Panel program window appears on the computer telling you  
the paper transfer belt needs to be replaced.  
The life span of the paper transfer belt may be affected by operating  
environment, printing interval, media type, and media size.  
1. Open the front door.  
If you leave the front door open for more than a few minutes, the  
5. Place the print cartridge on a flat surface, as shown, and remove the  
OPC drum in the toner cartridge can be exposed to light. This will  
cause damage to the OPC drum. Close the front door should the  
installation need to be halted for any reason.  
paper covering the print cartridge by removing the tape.  
If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash  
clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric.  
Do not touch the surface, the OPC drum in the cartridge. If the  
surface is contaminated, it might affect the printout quality. Use  
the handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area.  
2. Press the green release handle to release the paper transfer belt.  
Holding the handle on the paper transfer belt, lift it out of the machine.  
6. Hold the toner cartridge by the handle and slowly insert the cartridge into  
the opening in the machine. Ensure the color cartridge is placed in the  
correct position, see label in picture below for the correct color position  
for each cartridge.  
Tabs on the sides of the cartridge and corresponding grooves within the  
machine will guide the cartridge into the correct position until it locks into  
3. Remove a new paper transfer belt from its bag.  
4. Remove the paper covering the paper transfer belt.  
Do not use sharp objects, such as a knife or scissors, to open the  
paper transfer belt package. You could damage the surface of  
Supplies and accessories_ 3  
 
the paper transfer belt.  
Activating the added accessories in the PS driver properties.  
Be careful not to scratch the surface of the paper transfer belt.  
5. Holding the handle on the new paper transfer belt, align it with the slots  
After installing an accessory such as an optional tray, PS driver users  
must do the additional setting. Go to the PS printer properties and set  
the added accessory activated.  
on the inside of the front door.  
When installing accessories, the battery inside the machine is a  
service component and needs to be replaced by an authorized  
servicer. Do not change it by yourself.  
There is a risk of an explosion if battery is replaced by an incorrect  
type.  
Activating the added accessories in printer  
properties  
After installing added accessories, you need to select it in the printer  
properties of the printer driver in order to use it.  
2. Click the Windows Start menu.  
3. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
6. Lower the paper transfer belt until it is parallel with the front door and  
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and  
firmly seated.  
Sound > Printers.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Devices and Printers.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Devices and Printers.  
4. Right-click your machine.  
5. For Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, press Properties.  
For PS driver, select PS driver and right-click to open Properties.  
For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus,  
select the Printer properties.  
If Printer properties item has mark, you can select other  
printer drivers connected with selected printer.  
6. In printer driver properties, select Device Options.  
7. In printer driver properties, set the necessary options.  
8. Click OK.  
7. Close the front door to resume printing.  
Upgrading a memory module  
If the front door is not completely closed, the machine will not  
operate.  
Your machine supports DIMM (Dual Inline Memory Module). Use this  
memory module slot to install additional memory.  
When you are expanding the memory capacity, you can add a memory  
module to the vacant memory slot (See "Available accessories" on page 2).  
Necessary precautions to take when installing  
accessories  
We recommend the use of only genuine Samsung DIMM's. You may void  
your warranty if it is determined that your machine problem is being caused  
by third party DIMM's.  
Disconnect the power cord.  
To avoid the possibility of an electrical shock, always disconnect the  
power cord when installing or removing ANY internal or external  
accessories.  
Discharge static electricity.  
The control board and internal accessories (network interface card or  
memory module) are sensitive to static electricity. Before installing or  
removing any internal accessories, discharge static electricity from your  
body by touching something metal, such as the metal back plate on any  
device plugged into a grounded power source. If you walk around before  
finishing the installation, repeat this procedure to discharge any static  
electricity again.  
Supplies and accessories_ 4  
     
Installing a memory module  
1. Turn the machine off and unplug all cables from the machine.  
Printing with the optional memory (CLX-6250 Series  
only)  
2. Remove the screws and remove the rear cover.  
You can only use this feature if you have installed the 512 MB  
optional memory. (CLX-6250 Series only)  
After installing the optional memory, you can use advanced printing  
features, such as proofing a job and specifying of printing a private  
job in the printer properties window.  
Job Settings  
This option allows you to choose how to print the printing file by using  
the 512 MB optional memory.  
1.Open the document you want to print.  
2.Select Print from the File menu. The Print window appears.  
3.Select your printer driver from the Select Printer list.  
3. Remove the screws, then lift up the cover slightly and pull the cover to  
the right.  
The basic print settings including the number of copies and print  
range are selected within the Print window.  
1 Control board  
cover  
4.Access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on  
4. Remove the new memory module from its bag.  
page 2).  
5. Holding the memory module by the edges, align the memory module in  
the slot at about a 30-degree angle. Make sure that the notches of the  
module and the grooves on the slot fit each other.  
5.Click the Advanced tab then select Job Settings.  
6.Select the Print Mode you want .  
Normal: This mode prints without storing your document in the  
optional memory.  
Proof: This mode is useful when you print more than one copy.  
You can print one copy first to check, than print the rest of copies  
later.  
Confidential: This mode is used for printing confidential  
documents. You need to enter a password to print.  
7.Select OK.  
The notches and grooves illustrated above may not match those  
on an actual memory module and its slot.  
Controlling the active job queue  
All of the print jobs waiting to be printed are listed in the active job queue  
in the order you sent them to the printer. You can delete a job from the  
queue before printing, or promote a job to print sooner.  
6. Press the memory module into the slot with care until you hear a 'click'.  
Do not press the memory module strongly or the module may be  
damaged. If the module does not seem to fit into the slot properly,  
carefully try the previous procedure again.  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press left/right arrow until Job Management appears and press OK.  
3.Press left/right arrow until Active Job appears and press OK.  
7. Install the control board with the screw removed in step 3.  
8. Install the rear cover with the screw removed in step 2.  
9. Reconnect the power cord and printer cable, and turn the machine on.  
4.Press left/right arrow until the user’s name and file name you want to  
use appears and press OK.  
If the select file is a confidential print job, enter the specified  
4-digit password.  
Use the left/right arrow to enter digits. When you press OK, the  
cursor will move to the next character. When you finish  
entering the password, press OK.  
If you use the PS driver, you must activate the added memory in the  
PS driver properties  
page 4).  
Supplies and accessories_ 5  
   
If you enter the incorrect password, Invalid Password  
appears. Reenter the correct password.  
3. Remove the screws, then lift up the cover slightly and pull the cover to  
the right.  
5.Press the left/right arrow until the desired setting appears and press  
OK.  
Cancel: You can delete a file from the queue.  
Promote: You can select a job waiting in the active job queue and  
change its print order so that it can be printed sooner.  
Release: You can print a job scheduled to be printed at a specified  
time immediately. In this case, the job currently printing is  
stopped and the selected job will be printed. This function is  
available when the job is scheduled for later printing.  
6.When Yes appears, press OK.  
File Policy  
1 Control board  
cover  
You can choose the file policy for generating file name before you  
proceed with the job through optional memory. If the optional memory  
already has the same name when you entered a new file name, you can  
rename or overwrite it.  
4. Detach the dummy panel on your machine using a screwdriver. Be  
careful when removing not to damage the plastic cover.  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Job Management and press  
OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight File Policy and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight the desired setting and press  
OK.  
Rename : If the optional memory already has the same name  
when you enter a new file name, the file will be saved as a  
different name that is automatically programmed.  
Overwrite : You can set the machine to delete previous job  
information on optional memory as you store new job  
information.  
5. Take out a new wireless interface card from its bag.  
6. Place the wireless network interface card into the card guide [below item  
6.Press OK.  
3], ensure the connector side of the card is to the right.  
Installing a wireless network interface card  
Depending on your country, wireless LAN cards may not be available.  
Contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you bought  
your printer.  
The machine is equipped with a network interface which allows you to use  
your machine on a network. You can also purchase a wireless network  
interface card to enable the use of the machine in wireless network  
environments (See "Available accessories" on page 2).  
1 wireless network interface  
card connector  
2 wireless network interface  
card  
Installing a wireless network interface card  
1. Turn the machine off and unplug all cables from the machine.  
2. Remove the screws and remove the rear cover.  
3 wireless network interface  
card guide  
7. Align the wireless network card connector on the right side of the card  
with the connector on the control board [1].  
Press the wireless interface card [2] down firmly into the main connector  
[1] until it is completely and securely in place.  
Supplies and accessories_ 6  
 
Wizard mode  
1.The wireless network interface card on your machine searches for  
wireless network in the area and shows the results.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to select a network you want to use in  
Search List and press OK. You can select a network using SSID.  
3.When None appears in WLAN Security on the display, press OK to  
save your selection. go to step 6.  
If you see another messages, go to the next step.  
4.According to the network you select, WLAN security encryption type  
will be WEP or WPA.  
In case of WEP, Press the up/down to selcet Open System or  
1 Connector  
2 Wireless  
SharedKey.  
interface card  
-Open System: Authentication is not used, and Encryption  
may or may not be used, depending on the need for data  
security. Enter the WEP Key using number keypad after  
selecting Open System.  
8. Install the control board cover with the screws removed in step 3.  
-SharedKey: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper  
WEP Key can access the network. Enter the WEP Key using  
number keypad after selecting SharedKey.  
In case of WPA, Enter the WPA Key using number keypad. The  
Key length should be between 8 to 63 characters long.  
5.Press OK.  
6.Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
SSID: SSID (Service Set Identifier) is a name that identifies a  
wireless network. Access points and wireless devices  
attempting to connect to a specific wireless network must use  
the same SSID. The SSID is case-sensitive.  
WEP : WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol  
preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network.  
WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a  
wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key.  
WPA : WPA authorizes and identifies users based on a secret  
key that changes automatically at regular intervals. WPA also  
uses TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol) and AES  
(Advanced Encryption Standard) for data encryption.  
9. Install the rear cover with the screws removed in step 2.  
10. Plug all the cables back into the machine, and turn the machine on.  
11. Set the wireless network environment.  
For information about configuring and using the printer on a  
wireless network environment, refer to the Wireless network install  
guide provided with the wireless network interface card. You can  
also configure the network parameters on the control panel; see  
the next column.  
Custom mode  
Configuring the machine’s wireless network  
1.Enter the SSID when Edit SSID appears on the top line of the display,  
the name that identifies a wireless network. SSID is case-sensitive  
so you need to enter it carefully. Press OK.  
Before starting you will need to know the network name(SSID) of your  
wireless network and the network key if it is encrypted. This information was  
set when the wireless router(access point) was installed. If you do not know  
about your wireless environment, please ask the person who has set up  
your network.  
2.Select the type of wireless connections. Press the up/down arrow to  
select the method of Operation Mode you want and press OK.  
Ad-hoc: Allows wireless devices to communicate directly with each  
other in a peer-to-peer environment. Go to step 3.  
Infrastructure: Allows wireless devices to communicate with each  
To configure wireless parameters, you can use both control panel and  
SyncThru™ Web Service.  
other through an access point. Go to step 4.  
Using the control panel  
3.Press the up/down arrow to select the method of Channel you want  
and press OK. If you select Auto, the wireless network interface card  
on your machine will automatically adjust the channels.  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Network and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Wireless and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight WLAN Settings and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to select the method of WLAN Security you  
want and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to select the setup method you want is  
None: This is used when the validation of a wireless device’s  
identity and data encryption are not required for your network.  
Open system is used for IEEE 802.11 authentication.  
Static WEP: This uses the WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy)  
algorithm suggested by IEEE 802.11 standard for security. Static  
WEP security mode requires a proper WEP key for data  
encryption, decryption, and IEEE 802.11 authentication. Press  
the left/right arrow to select the setup method you want in  
Authentication and press OK.  
highlighted and press OK.  
Wizard: The wireless network interface card in your printer  
searches for wireless networks in the area and shows the results.  
Custom: You can configure the wireless settings according to your  
needs.  
Supplies and accessories_ 7  
-Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may  
or may not be used, depending on the need for data security.  
Enter the WEP Key using number keypad after selecting  
Open System and then press OK.  
3. Remove the screws, then lift up the cover slightly and pull the cover to  
the right.  
-SharedKey: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper  
WEP Key can access the network. Enter the WEP Key using  
number keypad after selecting SharedKey and then press  
OK.  
WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK: You can select WPA-PSK or  
WPA2-PSK to authenticate the print server based on WPA  
Pre-Shared Key. This uses a shared secret key (generally called  
Pre Shared Key passphrase) which is manually configured on  
the access point and each of its clients.  
a. Press OK when WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK appears on the  
bottom line of the display.  
b. Press the up/down arrow to select TKIP or AES in Encryption  
and press OK. If you select WPA2-PSK, press the up/down  
arrow to select AES or TKIP + AES in Encryption and press  
OK.  
1 Control board  
cover  
4. Take out a new hard disk from its plastic bag.  
5. Align the connector on the hard disk with the connector on the control  
board. Push the hard disk in until it is latched into place.  
c. Enter the WPA Key using number keypad and press OK.  
5.When you have finished, press Stop/Clear to return to the ready  
mode. If you do not know about your wireless environment, please  
ask the network administrator.  
Disconnect the network cable (standard or crossover). Your  
machine should then start communicating wirelessly with the  
network. In case of Ad-hoc mode, you can use a wireless LAN and  
wired LAN simultaneously.  
Using SyncThru™ Web Service  
6. Fasten down the hard disk with the screws supplied with your new hard  
For information about configuring and using the machine on a wireless  
network environment, refer to the Wireless network install guide  
provided with the wireless network interface card. You can also  
configure the network parameters on the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
disk; then reinstall the covers removed in steps 2 and 3.  
7. Reconnect the power cord and machine cable. Turn on the machine.  
8. You must activate the added hard disk in the driver properties  
Installing a hard disk  
Printing with the optional hard disk  
After installing the optional hard disk, you can use advanced printing  
features, such as storing or spooling a print job to the hard disk,  
proofing a job, and specifying of printing a private job in the printer  
properties window.  
Once you have stored files in the hard disk, you can easily print or  
delete the stored files using the control panel of your printer.  
Installing the hard disk allows the data from your computer to be sent to the  
print queue of the printer hard disk. This decreases the workload of the  
computer. You can also use various print features, such as storing a job in  
the hard disk, proofing a job, and printing private documents.  
The order information is provided for optional hard disk (See "Available  
Storing a job  
You can store jobs on the hard disk.  
Installing a hard disk  
1. Turn the machine off and unplug all cables from the machine.  
2. Remove the screws and remove the rear cover.  
1.Open the document you want to print.  
2.Select Print from the file menu. The Print window appears.  
3.Select your machine from Select Printer list.  
4.Click Properties or Preferences.  
5.Click the Advanced tab and click Job Setting.  
6.Select the print mode you want from the drop-down list  
7.Enter the user’s name and file name.  
8.Click OK until the Print window is displayed.  
9.Click OK or Print to start printing.  
Printing or deleting a stored job  
You can print or delete jobs stored on the hard disk.  
Supplies and accessories_ 8  
   
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
Creating new form files  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
Use the steps below to create a new form overlay.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Job Management and press  
1.Create or open a document containing text or an image for use in a  
OK.  
new form file.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Stored Job and press OK.  
2.To save the document as a form file, access Printing Preferences  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight the user’s name and file name  
you want use and press OK.  
3.Click the Advanced tab, and select Advanced.  
4.In the Advanced Output Options window, check Save as Form for  
If the select file is a confidential print job, enter the specified  
4-digit password.  
Overlay.  
5.Click Search.  
Use the up/down arrow to enter digits and use the left/right  
arrow to move between digits. When you finish entering the  
password, press OK.  
6.Type a file name of up to eight characters in the File name box. Select  
the destination path and click Save.  
If you enter the incorrect password, Invalid Password  
appears. Reenter the correct password.  
6.Press the up/down arrow to highlight the desired setting and press  
7.Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
8. A confirm message appears, click Yes to save.  
The file is not printed. Instead, it is stored on your computer hard disk  
drive.  
OK.  
Print: You can print a stored job.  
Delete: You can delete a stored job.  
7.When Yes appears, press OK.  
If you click NO, the machine prints your form without saving.  
9.A confirm message appears, click Yes to save.  
The form file size must be the same as the document you print with  
the form file.  
Controlling the active job queue  
All of the print jobs waiting to be printed are listed in the active job queue  
in the order you sent them to the printer. You can delete a job from the  
queue before printing, or promote a job to print sooner.  
Using form files on your machine’s hard disk  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Machine Setup and press OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Form Menu and press OK.  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Job Management and press  
OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow until the item you want appears and press  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Active Job and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight the user’s name and file name  
OK.  
Off: Prints in normal mode.  
Single Form: Prints all page using the first form.  
you want use and press OK.  
If the select file is a confidential print job, enter the specified  
4-digit password.  
Double Form: Prints the front page using the first form and the  
back page using the second form.  
Use the up/down arrow to enter digits and use the left/right  
arrow to move between digits. When you finnish entering the  
password, press OK.  
If you enter the incorrect password, Invalid Password  
appears. Reenter the correct password.  
6.Press Back.  
7.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Select Form and press OK.  
8.Press the up/down arrow until the item you want appears and press  
OK.  
9.Press the up/down arrow until the form file for the second form  
6.Press the up/down arrow to highlight the desired setting and press  
appears and press OK.  
OK.  
File Policy  
Cancel: You can delete a file from the queue.  
Promote: You can select a job waiting in the active job queue and  
You can choose the file policy for generating file name before you  
proceed with the job through hard disk drive (HDD). If the hard disk drive  
(HDD) memory already has the same name when you entered a new file  
name, you can rename or overwrite it.  
change its print order so that it can be printed sooner.  
Release: You can print a job scheduled to be printed at a specified  
time immediately. In this case, the job currently printing is  
stopped and the selected job will be printed. This function is  
available when the job is scheduled for later printing.  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Job Management and press  
7.When Yes appears, press OK.  
OK.  
Form file  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight File Policy and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight the desired setting and press  
Form overlay are images stored in the printer hard disk drive (HDD) as a  
special file format that can be printed in layers on any document.  
OK.  
Rename : If the hard disk drive (HDD) memory already has the  
Supplies and accessories_ 9  
same name when you enter a new file name, the file will be  
saved as a different name that is automatically programmed.  
Overwrite : You can set the machine to delete previous job  
information on hard disk drive (HDD) as you store new job  
information.  
6.Press OK.  
Deleting residual image data  
Image Overwrite is a security measure for customers who are  
concerned about unauthorized access and duplication of classified or  
private document.  
1.Press Menu on the control panel.  
2.Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Job Management and press  
OK.  
4.Press the up/down arrow to highlight Image Overwrite and press OK.  
5.Press the up/down arrow to highlight the desired setting and press  
OK.  
Immediate : All residual image data from the machine will be  
erased immediately after each job has been processed.  
On Demand : This option provides an on-demand facility for a  
system administrator to erase all the real image data remained in  
hard disk drive (HDD) after this option enabled. All existing jobs  
will be deleted regardless of their status and all job submissions  
will be prohibited for the duration of the overwrite.  
6.Press the up/down arrow to move to On or Off for Immediate.  
Press the up/down arrow to move to Enable or Disable for On  
Demand.  
If you selected On Demand enabled, the machine confirms if  
the overwrite feature starts now. Press the up/down arrow to  
select Yes or No. If you select Yes, On Demand overwrite  
starts as soon as you select Yes. If you select No, this feature  
will be enabled.  
7.Press OK.  
Checking replaceable’s lifespan  
If you experience frequent paper jams or printing problems, check the  
number of pages the machine has printed. Replace the corresponding  
parts, if necessary.  
1. Press Menu on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrow to highlight System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Maintenance and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrow to highlight Supplies Life and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrow until the item you want appears and press OK.  
6. Press Stop/Clear to return to ready mode.  
Supplies and accessories_ 10  
 
1.  
specifications  
This chapter guides you about this machine’s specifications.  
This chapter includes:  
The specification values are listed below, specification are subject to change without notice. See www.samsung.com/printer for possible changes in  
information.  
Hardware specifications  
Item  
Description  
Dimension  
Height  
651 mm (25.63 inches)  
498 mm (19.61 inches)  
468 mm (18.43 inches)  
37.40 Kg (82.45 lbs)  
5.8 Kg (12.7 lbs)  
Depth  
Width  
Weight  
Machine with consumables  
Package weight  
Paper  
Plastic  
1.8 Kg (3.9 lbs)  
Environmental specifications  
Item  
Description  
Noise Levela  
Ready mode  
35 dB(A )  
Printing mode  
CLX-6220 Series: 53 dB(A)  
CLX-6250 Series: 54 dB(A)  
Temperature  
Humidity  
Operation  
15 to 32 °C (59 to 89.6 °F)  
-20 to 40 °C (-4 to 104°F)  
20 to 80% RH  
Storage (Packed)  
Operation  
Storage (Packed)  
10 to 90% RH  
a.Sound Pressure Level, ISO 7779. Configuration tested: machine basic installation, A4 paper, simplex printing.  
Electrical specifications  
Power requirements are based on the country/region where the device is sold. Do not convert operating voltages. Doing so might damage the device and  
void the product warranty.  
Item  
Description  
Power ratinga  
110 volt models  
220 volt models  
AC 110 - 127 V  
AC 220 - 240 V  
Specifications_ 1  
       
Item  
Description  
CLX-6220 Series: Less than 550 W  
CLX-6250 Series: Less than 580 W  
CLX-6220 Series: Less than 33 W  
CLX-6250 Series: Less than 38 W  
CLX-6220 Series: Less than 11 W  
CLX-6250 Series: Less than 13 W  
Power consumption  
Average operating mode  
Ready mode  
Power save mode  
Power off mode  
Less than 1 W  
a.See the rating label on the machine for the correct voltage, frequency (hertz) and type of current for your machine.  
Specifications_ 2  
Print media specifications  
Print media weighta/Capacityb  
Type  
Size  
Dimensions  
tray1 / optional tray  
70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lbs bond)  
multi-purpose tray  
70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lbs bond)  
Plain paper  
Letter  
Legal  
US Folio  
A4  
216 x 279 mm (8.5 x 11 inches)  
216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches)  
216 x 330 mm (8.5 x 13 inches)  
210 x 297 mm (8.27 x 11.69 inches)  
216 x 343 mm (8.5 x 13.5 inches)  
182 x 257 mm (7.17 x 10.12 inches)  
176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84 inches)  
184 x 267 mm (7.25 x 10.5 inches)  
250 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond) for tray1  
100 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs bond)  
500 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond) for optional tray.  
Oficio  
JIS B5  
ISO B5  
70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lb bond)  
250 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond)  
Executive  
70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lb bond)  
A5  
148 x 210 mm (5.83 x 8.27 inches)  
140 x 216 mm (5.5 x 8.5 inches)  
105 x 148 mm (4.13 x 5.83 inches)  
250 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond) for tray1  
Statement  
A6  
Not available in optional tray.  
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lbs bond)  
10 sheets  
Envelope  
Envelope Monarch  
Envelope No. 10  
Envelope DL  
98 x 191 mm (3.87 x 7.5 inches)  
105 x 241 mm (4.12 x 9.5 inches)  
110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66 inches)  
162 x 229 mm (6.38 x 9.02 inches)  
114 x 162 mm (4.49 x 6.38 inches)  
98 x 225 mm (3.87 x 8.87 inches)  
92 x 165 mm (3.62 x 6.5 inches)  
Not available in tray1 / optional  
tray.  
Envelope C5  
Envelope C6  
Envelope No. 9  
Envelope 6 3/4  
90 to 105 g/m2 (24 to 28 lbs bond) 90 to 105 g/m2 (24 to 28 lbs bond)  
Thick paper  
Thin paper  
Refer to the Plain paper Refer to the Plain paper section  
section  
40 sheets  
250 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond) f or tray1.  
500 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond) for optional tray.  
60 to 70 g/m2 (16 to 19 lbs bond)  
60 to 70 g/m2 (16 to 19 lbs bond)  
100 sheets  
Refer to the Plain paper Refer to the Plain paper section  
section  
250 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond) f or tray1.  
500 sheets of 80 g/m2(20 lbs  
bond) for optional tray.  
106 to 120 g/m2 (28 to 32 lbs bond)  
10 sheets  
120 to 170 g/m2 (32 to 46 lbs bond)  
10 sheets  
120 to 150 g/m2 (32 to 40 lbs bond)  
10 sheets  
171 to 220 g/m2 ( 46 to 59 lbs bond)  
5 sheets  
111 to 220 g/m2 ( 30 to 59 lbs bond)  
1 sheet  
Thicker paper  
Extra thick  
Refer to the Plain paper Refer to the Plain paper section  
section  
Not available in tray1 / optional  
tray.  
Refer to the Plain paper Refer to the Plain paper section  
section  
Labelsc  
Refer to the Plain paper Refer to the Plain paper section  
section  
Card stock  
Refer to the Plain paper Refer to the Plain paper section  
section  
Glossy Photo,  
Matte Photo  
Refer to the Plain paper 100 x 150 mm (4 x 6 inches)  
section  
Minimum size (custom)  
Maximum size (custom)  
98 x 148 mm (3.9 x 5.8 inches)  
216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches)  
a.If media weight is over 105 g/m2 (28 lb bond), load a paper into the multi-purpose tray one by one.  
Specifications_ 3  
   
b.Maximum capacity may differ depending on media weight, thickness, and environmental conditions.  
c. Smoothness: 100 to 250 (sheffield).  
Specifications_ 4  
1.  
administrator’s guide (windows only)  
This chapter gives helpful information and troubleshooting tips for system administrators using Samsung Installer.  
4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the  
Overview  
License Agreement. Then, click Next.  
5. Select Client Group window appears.  
6. Click New Group.  
Samsung provides convenient installation methods useful for  
administrators. Administrators can remotely install the machine driver to  
multiple client computers or use command window to install the driver at  
once. Administrators can also make their own installation package for  
distribution.  
To use remote installation, you need at least a group. If you have  
already created a group, load the group you want and go to step 16.  
Edit Group: You can edit groups.  
Load Group: You can load groups.  
Delete Group: You can delete groups.  
Check the system requirements before installing the machine’s driver (See  
7. Log on window appears. Select Domain Remote Installation and type  
Remote installation  
in the administrator’s Domain, ID and Password.  
If your company has no domain network environment, you can use  
Workgroup Remote Installation (See "Workgroup Remote  
Remote Installation is provided under Administrator Installation menu. It  
is provided for administrators to remotely install device drivers and  
application software to multiple client computers. To use remote installation,  
you must configure at least one group. Multiple client computers can be  
added to a group that has the same installation configuration. Installation  
configuration includes device drivers or application software to be installed,  
port used for printing, default printer, printer name, sharing information and  
etc.  
8. Click Next.  
9. Select Clients window appears.  
10. Type in the group name in the Group Name field.  
11. Add the client computers to be in the group to the right side panel.  
You can click … button to search the client computers and add  
button to add a client computer by typing the IP address or the  
computer name of client.  
You can add up to 50 client computers in a group. If you want to  
add more than 50 client computers, you need to create more  
groups.  
For remote installation, all client computers must be joined to a  
domain or a workgroup and file sharing must be enabled to be  
accessed by remote installer software on both server and client sides.  
If you cannot access the client computers, you might need to disable  
the Firewall option on the client computers.  
Domain remote installation  
If the firewall is enabled on the client computer, access may be  
denied.  
The client computer’s operating system should be Windows 2000  
or higher.  
You need to be a member of domain administrator to use Domain  
Remote Installation.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network or USB and  
C drive must be shared as C$.  
powered on.  
12. Select Software and Utilities to Install window appears.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
Select the driver(s) and application software(s) you want to install and  
click Next.  
13. Select Printer connection window appears.  
The software CD should automatically run and an installation window  
appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive. Click OK.  
Select the printer connection type and click Next.  
If you selected Network Connection, Search Network Printers  
window appears, type in the IP address or host name in the  
information field than click Search. when you are finished, click  
Next.  
The discovered printer list will show network printers on the same  
subnet. If you want to specify a network printer that is located over  
subnet then specify IP address of network printer directly.  
If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2  
click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive and click OK.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, click Run  
Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue in the  
User Account Control windows.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows 7 and Windows 2008  
Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and  
click Yes in the User Account Control windows.  
14. Confirm Group details window appears.  
Check the group information and click Next.  
Location to save the group shows the path of default folder  
which stores the created group information. The group information  
file will be created as “<group_name>.RGI. You can change the  
path by clicking the Change button.  
3. Select Administrator Installation > Remote Installation.  
If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
15. Select Client Group window appears again.  
Administrator’s Guide (Windows only)_ 1  
   
16. Select the group(s) and click Next to start remote installation.  
11. Add the client computers to be in the group to the right side panel.  
Remote installation begins, you can see the installation status from the  
window.  
17. When installation is completed, Results of remote installation window  
You can click … button to search the client computers and add  
button to add the client computer by typing the IP address or  
the computer name of client.  
appears.  
You can add up to 50 client computers in a group. If you want to  
add more than 50 client computers, you need to create more  
groups.  
Check the result. For failed client computers, you can reinstall again by  
clicking the Reinstall button.  
If the firewall is enabled on the client computer, access may be  
denied.  
For failed client computers, you can check the log file which is  
created in the client computers.  
The client computer’s operating system should be Windows 2000  
or higher.  
If you have grouped the client computers in a workgroup and you  
try to connect to the client computer, a pop up window asking  
you to enter an Administrator's ID/password of the client  
computer you selected will appear if you can't access through  
the password you set in step 7.  
Workgroup Remote Installation  
You can also use remote installation method with workgroups.  
If your company has no domain network environment, you should use  
Workgroup Remote Installation.  
If the client computer uses Windows Vista or higher, ID should be  
Administrator.  
C drive must be shared as C$.  
12. Select Software and Utilities to Install window appears.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network or USB and  
powered on.  
Select the driver(s) and application software(s) you want to install and  
click Next.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
13. Select Printer connection window appears.  
The software CD should automatically run and an installation window  
appears.  
Select the printer connection type and click Next.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive. Click OK.  
If you selected Network Connection, Search Network Printers  
window appears, type in the IP address or host name in the  
information field than click Search. when you are finished, click  
Next.  
If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2  
click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive and click OK.  
The discovered printer list will show network printers on the same  
subnet. If you want to specify a network printer that is located over  
subnet then specify IP address of network printer directly.  
14. Confirm Group details window appears.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, click Run  
Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue in the  
User Account Control windows.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows 7 and Windows 2008  
Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and  
click Yes in the User Account Control windows.  
Check the group information and click Next.  
Location to save the group shows the path of default folder  
which stores the created group information. The group information  
file will be created as “<group_name>.RGI. You can change the  
path by clicking the Change button.  
3. Select Administrator Installation > Remote Installation.  
If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the  
License Agreement. Then, click Next.  
5. Select Client Group window appears.  
6. Click New Group.  
15. Select Client Group window appears again.  
16. Select the group(s) and click Next to start remote installation.  
Remote installation begins, you can see the installation status from the  
window.  
17. When installation is completed, Results of remote installation window  
appears.  
To use remote installation, you need at least a group. If you have  
already created a group, load the group you want and go to step 16.  
Edit Group: You can edit groups.  
Load Group: You can load groups.  
Delete Group: You can delete groups.  
Check the result. For failed client computers, you can reinstall again by  
clicking the Reinstall button.  
For failed client computers, you can check the log file which is  
created in the client computers.  
7. Log on window appears. Select Workgroup Remote Installation and  
type in the Workgroup, ID and Password.  
For Windows XP/2000/2003, the ID should be of a member of  
Administrators group for operating computers and for Windows  
Vista/2008/7, the ID should be of the default administrator  
account named Administrator.  
You can also use Domain Remote Installation (See "Domain  
8. Click Next.  
9. Select Clients window appears.  
10. Type in the group name in the Group Name field.  
Administrator’s Guide (Windows only)_ 2  
 
Error log messages  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested solutions  
N/A  
Check if the  
environment of client  
computer is supported  
for installation.  
Connection  
Error  
Unable to bind the socket. Restart the client  
[Port number:..]  
OS not  
supported  
computer.  
Unable to listen the  
socket. [Port number:..]  
Internet  
Explorer not  
supported  
Unable to connect to the  
client computer.  
MSXML not  
supported  
Client computer’s socket is  
closed.  
Insufficient free  
space  
Setup Error  
Unable to access the  
default shared folder(C$)  
in the client computer.  
Check if C drive  
folder is shared as  
C$.  
Check if you can  
remotely access the  
client computer’s C$  
folder on a network  
browser.  
Not  
Administrator  
Create Customized Installer  
Create Customized Installer allows administrators to create their own  
Unable to copy service  
files.  
Check if you can  
remotely access the  
client computer’s C$  
folder on the network  
browser.  
installation package with the installation setting you want. You can choose  
the drivers or software to be installed, assigned printer, printer name,  
sharing options, default printer and so on.  
The created installation package can be distributed as a single  
self-extraction EXE package to clients through file servers or special  
distribution servers. You can also create an install script file for silent  
installation.  
Unable to start the service Check whether  
on the client computer.  
RMInstallService  
program is running from  
Services. (From the  
Windows Start menu,  
select Control Panel >  
Administrative Tools >  
Services).  
If RMInstallService is  
stopped then restart it  
and try remote  
Creating a setup package  
You can create a setup package from CD to a local folder. The created  
setup package will include only selected device drivers or application.  
There are two types of setup package you can create. Normal(setup.exe)  
and Self-Extraction Package. Normal(setup.exe) will extract only  
selected driver or application files from CD. Self-Extraction Package will  
package like normal installation CD package as a single self-extractable  
setup.exe file.  
installation again.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network or USB and  
If you can't restart  
RMInstallService, then  
reboot client computer  
and try remote  
powered on.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
The software CD should automatically run and an installation window  
appears.  
installation again.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive. Click OK.  
Unable to create thread for Restart the client  
monitoring.  
computer.  
Unable to share folder on  
client computer.  
Check if the shared  
folder in the client  
computer can be shared  
with full control.  
If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2  
click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive and click OK.  
Unable to copy Installation  
files.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, click Run  
Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue in the  
User Account Control windows.  
Unable to execute the  
setup file normally.  
Check if the same  
model’s installer is  
running.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows 7 and Windows 2008  
Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and  
click Yes in the User Account Control windows.  
Check if the installer  
is waiting for a user  
input.  
3. Select Administrator Installation > Create Customized Installer.  
If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
Administrator’s Guide (Windows only)_ 3  
 
4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the  
License Agreement. Then, click Next.  
5. Select Package Type window appears.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, click Run  
Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue in the  
User Account Control windows.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows 7 and Windows 2008  
Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and  
click Yes in the User Account Control windows.  
Select Normal(setup.exe) or Self-Extraction Package.  
If you place the mouse cursor over the package type, you can see the  
detailed information on the bottom right side of the window.  
3. Select Administrator Installation > Create Customized Installer.  
If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the  
License Agreement. Then, click Next.  
5. Select Package Type window appears.  
6. Select Software and Utilities to Install window appears.  
Check the device drivers or application software you want to included in  
the setup package and click Next.  
7. Select Printer connection window appears.  
Select the printer connection type and click Next.  
Select Generate a Setup script file.  
If you place the mouse cursor over the package type, you can see the  
detailed information on the bottom right side of the window.  
If you selected Network Connection, Search Network Printers  
window appears, type in the IP address or host name in the  
information field than click Search. when you are finished, click  
Next.  
6. Select Software and Utilities to Install window appears.  
The discovered printer list will show network printers on the same  
subnet. If you want to specify a network printer that is located over  
subnet then specify IP address of network printer directly.  
Check the device drivers or application software you want to included in  
the setup package and click Next.  
7. Select Printer connection window appears.  
Select the printer connection type and click Next.  
If you can’t search network printers on the network then check  
whether your firewall setting is disabled. If it is enabled, disable  
firewall temporarily and try searching again.  
If you selected Network Connection, Search Network Printers  
window appears, type in the IP address or host name in the  
information field than click Search. when you are finished, click  
Next.  
The discovered printer list will show network printers on the same  
subnet. If you want to specify a network printer that is located over  
subnet then specify IP address of network printer directly.  
8. Set Printer Drivers window appears. Click Next.  
If necessary, configure printer name, sharing, shared name and default  
printer setting. If you changed settings then you should click Apply  
button to apply changes then click Next.  
9. Summary window appears. Check the package information and click  
If you can’t search network printers on the network then check  
whether your firewall setting is disabled. If it is enabled, disable  
firewall temporarily and try searching again.  
Next to start creating the setup package.  
You can modify the package configuration by clicking the Back button.  
Check the Install the package as silent mode, if you want to  
make the installation package as a silent installation package.  
Silent installation installs the driver automatically by the set option  
without user intervention.  
Setup configuration script filename is set as CONFIG.CI3 and it’s  
not changeable.  
8. Set Printer Drivers window appears. Click Next.  
If necessary, configure printer name, sharing, shared name and default  
printer setting. If you changed settings then you should click Apply  
button to apply changes then click Next.  
10. When creating the setup package is finished, Packaging Completed  
window appears.  
9. Summary window appears. Check the package information and click  
Check Open package folder upon completion if you want the created  
Next to start creating the setup package.  
package to open automatically after it’s created.  
You can modify the package configuration by clicking the Back button.  
11. Click Finish.  
Check the Install the package as silent mode, if you want to  
make the installation package as a silent installation package.  
Silent installation installs the driver automatically by the set option  
without user intervention.  
Creating a setup script file  
You can generate setup configuration script file based on the CD image. It  
can be used with Silent installation for distributing software to multiple client  
computers. For example, you can upload a full CD setup files into a file  
server then distribute batch file or log-on script file that executes silent  
installation with this customized script file(ex: \\<file_server>\CD\setup.exe  
/s /i”c:\temp\CONFIG.CI3).  
10. When creating the setup package is finished, Packaging Completed  
window appears.  
Check Open package folder upon completion if you want the created  
package to open automatically after it’s created.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network or USB and  
11. Click Finish.  
powered on.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
Modifying a setup script file  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network or USB and  
The software CD should automatically run and an installation window  
appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive. Click OK.  
powered on.  
2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
The software CD should automatically run and an installation window  
appears.  
If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2  
click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive and click OK.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive. Click OK.  
Administrator’s Guide (Windows only)_ 4  
 
If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2  
Command-line Parameters  
click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run.  
Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents  
your CD-ROM drive and click OK.  
Following table shows commands that can be used in the command window  
or in making a script file (See "Creating a setup script file" on page 4).  
Following command-line are effective and operated when command is  
used with /s or /S. But /h, /H or /? are exceptional commands that can  
be operated solely.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, click Run  
Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue in the  
User Account Control windows.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows 7 and Windows 2008  
Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and  
click Yes in the User Account Control windows.  
Command-  
Definition  
Description  
line  
3. Select Administrator Installation > Create Customized Installer.  
If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the  
License Agreement. Then, click Next.  
5. Select Package Type window appears.  
/s or  
/S  
Starts silent installation.  
Installs machine drivers  
without prompting any UIs  
or user intervention.  
/p”<port  
name>” or  
/P”<port  
name>”  
Specifies printer port.  
Printer port name can be  
specified as IP address,  
hostname, USB local port  
name or IEEE1284 port  
name.  
Network Port will be  
created by use of  
Standard TCP/IP Port  
monitor. For local port,  
this port must exist on  
system before being  
specified by  
Select Modify Script.  
If you place the mouse cursor over the package type, you can see the  
detailed information on the bottom right side of the window.  
6. Open the script file you want to modify(ex:CONFIG.CI3).  
For example  
/p”xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx” in  
where, “xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx”  
means IP address for  
network printer.  
CONFIG.CI3 script file will exist in \Setup\Script subfolder of the  
created setup package.  
command.  
7. Select Printer connection window appears.  
/p”USB001”, /P”LPT1:”,  
/p”hostname”  
When installing the  
driver silently in Korean,  
type in-Setup.exe /s  
/L"0x0012” or  
Select the printer connection type and click Next.  
If you selected Network Connection, Search Network Printers  
window appears, type in the IP address or host name in the  
information field than click Search. when you are finished, click  
Next.  
The discovered printer list will show network printers on the same  
subnet. If you want to specify a network printer that is located over  
subnet then specify IP address of network printer directly.  
Setup.exe /s /L"18” .  
/l”<Lang_cod Sets language code.  
e>” or  
Decimal number and  
hexadecimal number can  
be used but hexadecimal  
number must have prefix  
with “0X”. Refer to  
Language Codes section for  
available <Lang_code>.  
This command applies to all  
machine’s drivers and  
application software if  
specified language is  
If you can’t search network printers on the network then check  
whether your firewall setting is disabled. If it is enabled, disable  
firewall temporarily and try searching again.  
The default language  
/L”<Lang_co  
de>”  
will be decided  
automatically if there  
is no specified  
Setup configuration script filename is set as CONFIG.CI3 and it’s  
not changeable.  
8. Set Printer Drivers window appears. Click Next.  
installation language  
commanded. The  
default language  
depends on your  
system locale  
If necessary, configure printer name, sharing, shared name and default  
printer setting. If you changed settings then you should click Apply  
button to apply changes then click Next.  
information.  
9. Summary window appears. Check the package information and click  
supported. All software  
included in the machine’s  
drivers will be installed as  
the specified language.  
Next to start creating the setup package.  
You can modify the package configuration by clicking the Back button.  
10. When creating the setup package is finished, Packaging Completed  
Setup.exe /s /L"0x0012”  
or Setup.exe /s /L"18” ;  
install setup package  
silently with Korean.  
window appears.  
Check Open package folder upon completion if you want the created  
package to open automatically after it’s created.  
11. Click Finish.  
/a”<dest_pat  
h>” or  
/A”<dest_pat  
h>”  
Specifies destination path  
for installation.  
Since machine drivers  
should be installed on the  
OS specific location, this  
command applies to only  
application software.  
Silent installation Mode  
The destination path  
should be a fully  
qualified path.  
Silent installation mode is an installation method that does not require any  
user intervention. Once you start the installation, the machine driver and  
software are automatically installed on you computer. You can start the  
silent installation by typing /s or /S in the command window. Silent  
installation can also be performed by using the command script file  
Administrator’s Guide (Windows only)_ 5  
Command-  
line  
Command-  
line  
Definition  
Description  
Definition  
Description  
/i”<script  
Specifies customized install Customized script file can  
/o or  
/O  
Opens Printers and Faxes This command will open  
filename>” or script file for custom  
/I”<script  
filename>”  
be assigned for customized  
silent installation. This script  
file can be created or  
modified through provided  
installer customizing utility  
or by text editor.  
folder after installation.  
Printers and Faxes folder  
after the silent installation.  
operation.  
The script filename  
should be a fully  
qualified filename.  
/f”<log  
filename>” or  
/F”<log  
filename>”  
Specifies log filename.  
The default log file is  
It will create a log file to a  
specified folder.  
created in the system temp  
folder if not specified.  
Note: This customized  
script file is prior than  
default installer setting in  
setup package but not prior  
than command-line  
/h, /H or /?  
Shows Command-line  
Usage.  
Language code  
parameters.  
Code  
Language  
/n”<Printer  
name>” or  
/N”<Printer  
name>”  
Specifies printer name.  
Printer instance shall be  
created as specified printer  
name.  
With this parameter, you  
can add printer instances as  
your wishes.  
0X0009  
English  
0X0012  
0X0804  
0X0404  
0x040c  
0X0007  
0X0010  
0X000a  
0X0013  
0X001D  
0X0006  
0X000b  
0X0014  
0X0019  
0X0005  
0X000e  
0X0008  
0X0816  
0X0416  
0X0015  
0X001F  
0X0001  
0X000D  
0x0424  
0X0418  
0X0402  
0X041A  
0X081A  
Korean  
/nd or  
/ND  
Commands not to set the  
installed driver as a default  
machine driver.  
It indicates installed  
Simplified Chinese  
machine driver will not be  
the default machine driver  
on your system if there are  
one or more printer drivers  
installed. If there is no  
installed machine driver on  
your system, then this  
option won’t be applied  
because Windows OS will  
set installed printer driver as  
a default machine driver.  
Traditional Chinese  
French  
German  
Italian  
Spanish  
Dutch  
Swedish  
/x or  
/X  
Uses existing machine  
driver files to create printer  
instance if it is already  
installed.  
This command provides a  
way to install a printer  
instance that uses installed  
printer driver files without  
installing an additional  
driver.  
Danish  
Finnish  
Norwegian  
Russian  
/up”<printer  
name>” or  
/UP”<printer  
name>”  
Removes only specified  
printer instance and not the way to remove only  
driver files.  
This command provides a  
Czech  
Hungarian  
Greek  
specified printer instance  
from your system without  
effecting other printer  
drivers. It will not remove  
printer driver files from your  
system.  
Standard Portuguese  
Brazilian Portuguese  
Polish  
/d or  
/D  
Uninstalls all device drivers This command will remove  
and applications from your  
system.  
all installed device drivers  
and application software  
from your system.  
Turkish  
Arabic  
Hebrew  
/v”<share  
name>” or  
/V”<share  
name>”  
Shares installed machine  
and add other available  
platform drivers for Point &  
Print.  
It will install all supported  
Windows OS platform’s  
machine drivers to system  
and share it with specified  
<share name> for point and  
print.  
Slovenian  
Romanian  
Bulgarian  
Croatian  
Serbian  
Administrator’s Guide (Windows only)_ 6  
Create Customized Installer related questions  
Code  
Language  
No.  
Question  
Answer  
0X0422  
0X041B  
0X0421  
0x041E  
0X0429  
Ukraine  
Slovakia  
Indonesian  
Thai  
1
When I try to open the  
CONFIG.CI3 script file,  
the files doesn’t open and manufacture, model and script file  
a warning message pops type. Check the <MFG>,<MDL> node  
When the Custom utility opens the  
config.ci3 script file, it checks  
up.  
of the file you want to open, and if  
<SCRIPT_TYPE> value is ‘Config’.  
Farsi  
2
3
I cannot precede the next It checks if the IP address/hostname  
step at Search Network  
Printer dialog.  
is valid or not. You can specify only  
the IP address/hostname which is  
connected via network currently.  
Check the connection status of the  
printer to specify.  
Frequently Asked Question  
Remote Installation related questions  
No.  
Question  
Answer  
When I execute the  
customized installer  
package, the welcome  
If you want to install as silent mode,  
check the Install the package as  
silent mode check box in the  
1
Client computers are not  
listed in the list when  
logging on as a domain.  
Primary DNS address in all client  
computers should be specified as  
your domain server.  
dialog appears and I need Summary window.  
to select the options  
again.  
If the client computer is turned off,  
turn it on.  
2
Cannot access” error  
message appears during  
workgroup remote  
installation.  
This error message appears if access  
was denied. You should check the  
settings of network access; sharing  
and security model for local accounts.  
From the Windows Start menu,  
click Control Panel >  
Administrative Tools >Local  
Security Policy > Local Policies  
> Security Options > Network  
access: Sharing and security  
model for local accounts.  
If the setting is not Classic – local  
users authenticate as  
themselves, change it to Classic  
– local users authenticate as  
themselves.  
3
Cannot access” error  
message appears during  
domain / workgroup  
remote installation  
Check if the C drive folder is shared.  
C Drive folder should be shared as  
C$ to access remote client  
computers.  
Administrator’s Guide (Windows only)_ 7  
contact samsung worldwide  
If you have any comments or questions regarding Samsung products, contact the Samsung customer care center.  
Country/Regio  
Country/Regio  
n
Customer Care Center  
Web Site  
Customer Care Center  
Web Site  
n
HONG KONG  
3698-4698  
www.samsung.com/hk_e  
ARGENTINE  
AUSTRALIA  
AUSTRIA  
0800-333-3733  
1300 362 603  
0810-SAMSUNG (7267864, www.samsung.com/at  
€ 0.07/min)  
HUNGARY  
INDIA  
06-80-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
BELARUS  
BELGIUM  
810-800-500-55-500  
www.samsung.com/ua_r  
3030 8282  
1800 110011  
1800 3000 8282  
02 201 2418  
www.samsung.com/be  
www.samsung.com/be_fr  
INDONESIA  
ITALIA  
0800-112-8888  
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com/it  
JAMAICA  
JAPAN  
1-800-234-7267  
0120-327-527  
8000-7267  
BRAZIL  
0800-124-421  
4004-0000  
LATVIA  
CANADA  
1-800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
LITHUANIA  
LUXEMBURG  
MALAYSIA  
MEXICO  
8-800-77777  
02 261 03 710  
1800-88-9999  
CHILE  
CHINA  
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com/cl  
400-810-5858  
010-6475 1880  
01-800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
COLOMBIA  
01-8000112112  
0-800-507-7267  
MOLDOVA  
00-800-500-55-500  
www.samsung.com/ua_r  
COSTA RICA  
CZECH  
REPUBLIC  
800-SAMSUNG  
(800-726786)  
NETHERLANDS 0900-SAMSUNG  
(0900-7267864) (€  
Samsung Zrt., česká organizační složka, Oasis Florenc,  
Sokolovská394/17, 180 00, Praha 8  
0,10/min)  
DENMARK  
ECUADOR  
EL SALVADOR  
ESTONIA  
8-SAMSUNG (7267864)  
1-800-10-7267  
800-6225  
NEW ZEALAND  
0800 SAMSUNG (0800 726 www.samsung.com/nz  
786)  
NICARAGUA  
NORWAY  
00-1800-5077267  
3-SAMSUNG (7267864)  
800-7267  
800-7267  
PANAMA  
KAZAKHSTAN  
KYRGYZSTAN  
FINLAND  
8-10-800-500-55-500  
00-800-500-55-500  
30-6227 515  
PHILIPPINES  
1800-10-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
1-800-3-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
1-800-8-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
FRANCE  
01 4863 0000  
GERMANY  
01805 - SAMSUNG  
(726-7864 € 0,14/min)  
02-5805777  
GUATEMALA  
HONDURAS  
1-800-299-0013  
800-7919267  
POLAND  
0 801 1SAMSUNG  
(172678)  
022-607-93-33  
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide_ 1  
Country/Regio  
n
Customer Care Center  
Web Site  
PORTUGAL  
80820-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
PUERTO RICO  
1-800-682-3180  
REP. DOMINICA 1-800-751-2676  
EIRE  
0818 717 100  
RUSSIA  
SINGAPORE  
8-800-555-55-55  
1800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
SLOVAKIA  
0800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
SOUTH AFRICA 0860 SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
SPAIN  
902-1-SAMSUNG(902 172  
678)  
SWEDEN  
0771 726 7864  
(SAMSUNG)  
SWITZERLAND  
0848-SAMSUNG (7267864, www.samsung.com/ch  
CHF 0.08/min)  
TADJIKISTAN  
TAIWAN  
8-10-800-500-55-500  
0800-329-999  
THAILAND  
1800-29-3232  
02-689-3232  
TRINIDAD &  
TOBAGO  
1-800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
TURKEY  
U.A.E  
444 77 11  
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com/ae  
8000-4726  
U.K  
0845 SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
U.S.A  
1-800-SAMSUNG  
(7267864)  
UKRAINE  
8-800-502-0000  
www.samsung.com/ua_r  
UZBEKISTAN  
VENEZUELA  
VIETNAM  
8-10-800-500-55-500  
0-800-100-5303  
1 800 588 889  
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide_ 2  
glossary  
The following glossary helps you get familiar with the product by  
understanding the terminologies commonly used with printing as well  
as mentioned in this user’s guide.  
CCD  
Charge Coupled Device (CCD) is a hardware which enables the scan  
job. CCD Locking mechanism is also used to hold the CCD module to  
prevent any damage when you move the machine.  
802.11  
802.11 is a set of standards for wireless local area network (WLAN)  
communication, developed by the IEEE LAN/MAN Standards  
Committee (IEEE 802).  
Collation  
Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy job in sets. When  
collation is selected, the device prints an entire set before printing  
additional copies.  
802.11b/g  
802.11b/g can share same hardware and use the 2.4 GHz band.  
802.11b supports bandwidth up to 11 Mbps; 802.11g up to 54 Mbps.  
802.11b/g devices may occasionally suffer interference from microwave  
ovens, cordless telephones, and Bluetooth devices.  
Control Panel  
A control panel is a flat, typically vertical, area where control or  
monitoring instruments are displayed. They are typically found in front of  
the machine.  
Access point  
Coverage  
Access Point or Wireless Access Point (AP or WAP) is a device that  
connects wireless communication devices together on wireless local  
area networks (WLAN), and acts as a central transmitter and receiver of  
WLAN radio signals.  
It is the printing term used for a toner usage measurement on printing.  
For example, 5% coverage means that an A4 sided paper has about 5%  
image or text on it. So, if the paper or original has complicated images or  
lots of text on it, the coverage will be higher and at the same time, a  
toner usage will be as much as the coverage.  
ADF  
An Automatic Document Feeder (ADF) is a mechanism that will  
automatically feed an original sheet of paper so that the machine can  
scan some amount of the paper at once.  
CSV  
Comma Separated Values (CSV). A type of file format, CSV is used to  
exchange data between disparate applications. The file format, as it is  
used in Microsoft Excel, has become a de facto standard throughout the  
industry, even among non-Microsoft platforms.  
AppleTalk  
AppleTalk is a proprietary suite of protocols developed by Apple, Inc for  
computer networking. It was included in the original Macintosh (1984)  
and is now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking.  
DADF  
A Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) is a mechanism that will  
automatically feed and turn over an original sheet of paper so that the  
machine can scan on both sides of the paper.  
BIT Depth  
A computer graphics term describing the number of bits used to  
represent the color of a single pixel in a bitmapped image. Higher color  
depth gives a broader range of distinct colors. As the number of bits  
increases, the number of possible colors becomes impractically large for  
a color map. 1-bit color is commonly called as monochrome or black and  
white.  
Default  
The value or setting that is in effect when taking a printer out of its box  
state, reset, or initialized.  
DHCP  
A Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is a client-server  
networking protocol. A DHCP server provides configuration parameters  
specific to the DHCP client host requesting, generally, information  
required by the client host to participate on an IP network. DHCP also  
provides a mechanism for allocation of IP addresses to client hosts.  
BMP  
A bitmapped graphics format used internally by the Microsoft Windows  
graphics subsystem (GDI), and used commonly as a simple graphics file  
format on that platform.  
BOOTP  
DIMM  
Bootstrap Protocol. A network protocol used by a network client to  
obtain its IP address automatically. This is usually done in the bootstrap  
process of computers or operating systems running on them. The  
BOOTP servers assign the IP address from a pool of addresses to each  
client. BOOTP enables 'diskless workstation' computers to obtain an IP  
address prior to loading any advanced operating system.  
Dual Inline Memory Module (DIMM), a small circuit board that holds  
memory. DIMM stores all the data within the machine like printing data,  
received fax data.  
Glossary_ 1  
 
DNS  
EtherTalk  
The Domain Name Server (DNS) is a system that stores information  
associated with domain names in a distributed database on networks,  
such as the Internet.  
A suite of protocols developed by Apple Computer for computer  
networking. It was included in the original Macintosh (1984) and is now  
deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking.  
Dot Matrix Printer  
FDI  
A dot matrix printer refers to a type of computer printer with a print head  
that runs back and forth on the page and prints by impact, striking an  
ink-soaked cloth ribbon against the paper, much like a typewriter.  
Foreign Device Interface (FDI) is a card installed inside the machine to  
allow a third party device such as a coin operated device or a card  
reader. Those devices allow the pay-for-print service on your machine.  
DPI  
FTP  
Dots Per Inch (DPI) is a measurement of resolution that is used for  
scanning and printing. Generally, higher DPI results in a higher  
resolution, more visible detail in the image, and a larger file size.  
A File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a commonly used protocol for  
exchanging files over any network that supports the TCP/IP protocol  
(such as the Internet or an intranet).  
DRPD  
Fuser Unit  
Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection. Distinctive Ring is a telephone  
company service which enables a user to use a single telephone line to  
answer several different telephone numbers.  
The part of a laser printer that fuses the toner onto the print media. It  
consists of a heat roller and a pressure roller. After toner is transferred  
onto the paper, the fuser unit applies heat and pressure to ensure that  
the toner stays on the paper permanently, which is why paper is warm  
when it comes out of a laser printer.  
Duplex  
A mechanism that will automatically turn over a sheet of paper so that  
the machine can print (or scan) on both sides of the paper. A printer  
equipped with a Duplex Unit can print on both sides of paper during one  
print cycle.  
Gateway  
A connection between computer networks, or between a computer  
network and a telephone line. It is very popular, as it is a computer or a  
network that allows access to another computer or network.  
Duty Cycle  
Grayscale  
Duty cycle is the page quantity which does not affect printer  
performance for a month. Generally the printer has the lifespan limitation  
such as pages per year. The lifespan means the average capacity of  
print-outs, usually within the warranty period. For example, if the duty  
cycle is 48,000 pages per month assuming 20 working days, a printer  
limits 2,400 pages a day.  
A shades of gray that represent light and dark portions of an image  
when color images are converted to grayscale; colors are represented  
by various shades of gray.  
Halftone  
An image type that simulates grayscale by varying the number of dots.  
Highly colored areas consist of a large number of dots, while lighter  
areas consist of a smaller number of dots.  
ECM  
Error Correction Mode (ECM) is an optional transmission mode built into  
Class 1 fax machines or fax modems. It automatically detects and  
corrects errors in the fax transmission process that are sometimes  
caused by telephone line noise.  
HDD  
Hard Disk Drive (HDD), commonly referred to as a hard drive or hard  
disk, is a non-volatile storage device which stores digitally-encoded data  
on rapidly rotating platters with magnetic surfaces.  
Emulation  
Emulation is a technique of one machine obtaining the same results as  
another.  
An emulator duplicates the functions of one system with a different  
system, so that the second system behaves like the first system.  
Emulation focuses on exact reproduction of external behavior, which is  
in contrast to simulation, which concerns an abstract model of the  
system being simulated, often considering its internal state.  
IEEE  
The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) is an  
international non-profit, professional organization for the advancement  
of technology related to electricity.  
IEEE 1284  
The 1284 parallel port standard was developed by the Institute of  
Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE). The term "1284-B" refers to  
a specific connector type on the end of the parallel cable that attaches to  
the peripheral (for example, a printer).  
Ethernet  
Ethernet is a frame-based computer networking technology for local  
area networks (LANs). It defines wiring and signaling for the physical  
layer, and frame formats and protocols for the media access control  
(MAC)/data link layer of the OSI model. Ethernet is mostly standardized  
as IEEE 802.3. It has become the most widespread LAN technology in  
use during the 1990s to the present.  
Glossary_ 2  
compression of binary images, particularly for faxes, but can also be  
used on other images.  
Intranet  
A private network that uses Internet Protocols, network connectivity, and  
possibly the public telecommunication system to securely share part of  
an organization's information or operations with its employees.  
Sometimes the term refers only to the most visible service, the internal  
website.  
JPEG  
Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) is a most commonly used  
standard method of lossy compression for photographic images. It is the  
format used for storing and transmitting photographs on the World Wide  
Web.  
IP address  
An Internet Protocol (IP) address is a unique number that devices use in  
order to identify and communicate with each other on a network utilizing  
the Internet Protocol standard.  
LDAP  
The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is a networking  
protocol for querying and modifying directory services running over  
TCP/IP.  
IPM  
The Images Per Minute (IPM) is a way of measuring the speed of a  
printer. An IPM rate indicates the number of single-sided sheets a printer  
can complete within one minute.  
LED  
A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is a semiconductor device that indicates  
the status of a machine.  
IPP  
The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for  
printing as well as managing print jobs, media size, resolution, and so  
forth. IPP can be used locally or over the Internet to hundreds of  
printers, and also supports access control, authentication, and  
encryption, making it a much more capable and secure printing solution  
than older ones.  
MAC address  
Media Access Control (MAC) address is a unique identifier associated  
with a network adapter. MAC address is a unique 48-bit identifier usually  
written as 12 hexadecimal characters grouped in pairs (e. g.,  
00-00-0c-34-11-4e). This address is usually hard-coded into a Network  
Interface Card (NIC) by its manufacturer, and used as an aid for routers  
trying to locate machines on large networks.  
IPX/SPX  
IPX/SPX stands for Internet Packet Exchange/Sequenced Packet  
Exchange. It is a networking protocol used by the Novell NetWare  
operating systems. IPX and SPX both provide connection services  
similar to TCP/IP, with the IPX protocol having similarities to IP, and  
SPX having similarities to TCP. IPX/SPX was primarily designed for  
local area networks (LANs), and is a very efficient protocol for this  
purpose (typically its performance exceeds that of TCP/IP on a LAN).  
MFP  
Multi Function Peripheral (MFP) is an office machine that includes the  
following functionality in one physical body, so as to have a printer, a  
copier, a fax, a scanner and etc.  
MH  
Modified Huffman (MH) is a compression method for decreasing the  
amount of data that needs to be transmitted between the fax machines  
to transfer the image recommended by ITU-T T.4. MH is a  
codebook-based run-length encoding scheme optimized to efficiently  
compress white space. As most faxes consist mostly of white space, this  
minimizes the transmission time of most faxes.  
ISO  
The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) is an  
international standard-setting body composed of representatives from  
national standards bodies. It produces world-wide industrial and  
commercial standards.  
MMR  
ITU-T  
Modified Modified READ (MMR) is a compression method  
recommended by ITU-T T.6.  
The International Telecommunication Union is an international  
organization established to standardize and regulate international radio  
and telecommunications. Its main tasks include standardization,  
allocation of the radio spectrum, and organizing interconnection  
arrangements between different countries to allow international phone  
calls. A -T out of ITU-T indicates telecommunication.  
Modem  
A device that modulates a carrier signal to encode digital information,  
and also demodulates such a carrier signal to decode transmitted  
information.  
ITU-T No. 1 chart  
Standardized test chart published by ITU-T for document facsimile  
transmissions.  
MR  
Modified Read (MR) is a compression method recommended by ITU-T  
T.4. MR encodes the first scanned line using MH. The next line is  
compared to the first, the differences determined, and then the  
differences are encoded and transmitted.  
JBIG  
Joint Bi-level Image Experts Group (JBIG) is an image compression  
standard with no loss of accuracy or quality, which was designed for  
Glossary_ 3  
NetWare  
PPM  
A network operating system developed by Novell, Inc. It initially used  
cooperative multitasking to run various services on a PC, and the  
network protocols were based on the archetypal Xerox XNS stack.  
Today NetWare supports TCP/IP as well as IPX/SPX.  
Pages Per Minute (PPM) is a method of measurement for determining  
how fast a printer works, meaning the number of pages a printer can  
produce in one minute.  
PRN file  
OPC  
An interface for a device driver, this allows software to interact with the  
device driver using standard input/output system calls, which simplifies  
many tasks.  
Organic Photo Conductor (OPC) is a mechanism that makes a virtual  
image for print using a laser beam emitted from a laser printer, and it is  
usually green or rust colored and a cylinder shaped.  
An imaging unit containing a drum slowly wears the drum surface by its  
usage in the printer, and it should be replaced appropriately since it gets  
worn from grits of a paper and the drum cleaning blade.  
Protocol  
A convention or standard that controls or enables the connection,  
communication, and data transfer between two computing endpoints.  
Originals  
PS  
The first example of something, such as a document, photograph or text,  
etc, which is copied, reproduced or translated to produce others, but  
which is not itself copied or derived from something else.  
See PostScript.  
PSTN  
The Public-Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) is the network of the  
world's public circuit-switched telephone networks which, on industrial  
premises, is usually routed through the switchboard.  
OSI  
Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) is a model developed by the  
International Organization for Standardization (ISO) for communications.  
OSI offers a standard, modular approach to network design that divides  
the required set of complex functions into manageable, self-contained,  
functional layers. The layers are, from top to bottom, Application,  
Presentation, Session, Transport, Network, Data Link and Physical.  
RADIUS  
Remote Authentication Dial In User Service (RADIUS) is a protocol for  
remote user authentication and accounting. RADIUS enables  
centralized management of authentication data such as usernames and  
passwords using an AAA (authentication, authorization, and accounting)  
concept to manage network access.  
PABX  
A private automatic branch exchange (PABX) is an automatic telephone  
switching system within a private enterprise.  
Resolution  
The sharpness of an image, measured in Dots Per Inch (DPI). The  
higher the dpi, the greater the resolution.  
PCL  
Printer Command Language (PCL) is a Page Description Language  
(PDL) developed by HP as a printer protocol and has become an  
industry standard. Originally developed for early inkjet printers, PCL has  
been released in varying levels for thermal, dot matrix printer, and  
xerographic printers.  
SMB  
Server Message Block (SMB) is a network protocol mainly applied to  
share files, printers, serial ports, and miscellaneous communications  
between nodes on a network. It also provides an authenticated  
Inter-process communication mechanism.  
PDF  
Portable Document Format (PDF) is a proprietary file format developed  
by Adobe Systems for representing two dimensional documents in a  
device independent and resolution independent format.  
SMTP  
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) is the standard for e-mail  
transmissions across the Internet. SMTP is a relatively simple,  
text-based protocol, where one or more recipients of a message are  
specified, and then the message text is transferred. It is a client-server  
protocol, where the client transmits an email message to the server.  
PostScript  
PostScript (PS) is a page description language and programming  
language used primarily in the electronic and desktop publishing areas. -  
that is run in an interpreter to generate an image.  
SSID  
Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name of a wireless local area network  
(WLAN). All wireless devices in a WLAN use the same SSID in order to  
communicate with each other. The SSIDs are case-sensitive and have a  
maximum length of 32 characters.  
Printer Driver  
A program used to send commands and transfer data from the computer  
to the printer.  
Print Media  
The media like paper, envelopes, labels, and transparencies which can  
be used in a printer, a scanner, a fax or, a copier.  
Glossary_ 4  
Subnet Mask  
Watermark  
The subnet mask is used in conjunction with the network address to  
determine which part of the address is the network address and which  
part is the host address.  
A watermark is a recognizable image or pattern in paper that appears  
lighter when viewed by transmitted light. Watermarks were first  
introduced in Bologna, Italy in 1282; they have been used by  
papermakers to identify their product, and also on postage stamps,  
currency, and other government documents to discourage  
counterfeiting.  
TCP/IP  
The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP);  
the set of communications protocols that implement the protocol stack  
on which the Internet and most commercial networks run.  
WEP  
Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) is a security protocol specified in IEEE  
802.11 to provide the same level of security as that of a wired LAN. WEP  
provides security by encrypting data over radio so that it is protected as  
it is transmitted from one end point to another.  
TCR  
Transmission Confirmation Report (TCR) provides details of each  
transmission such as job status, transmission result and number of  
pages sent. This report can be set to print after each job or only after  
failed transmissions.  
WIA  
Windows Imaging Architecture (WIA) is an imaging architecture that is  
originally introduced in Windows Me and Windows XP. A scan can be  
initiated from within these operating systems by using a WIA-compliant  
scanner.  
TIFF  
Tagged Image File Format (TIFF) is a variable-resolution bitmapped  
image format. TIFF describes image data that typically come from  
scanners. TIFF images make use of tags, keywords defining the  
characteristics of the image that is included in the file. This flexible and  
platform-independent format can be used for pictures that have been  
made by various image processing applications.  
WPA  
Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA) is a class of systems to secure wireless  
(Wi-Fi) computer networks, which was created to improve upon the  
security features of WEP.  
Toner Cartridge  
WPA-PSK  
A kind of bottle or container within a machine like a printer which  
contains toner. Toner is a powder used in laser printers and  
photocopiers, which forms the text and images on the printed paper.  
Toner can be fused by the heat of the fuser, causing it to bind to the  
fibers in the paper.  
WPA-PSK (WPA Pre-Shared Key) is special mode of WPA for small  
business or home users. A shared key, or password, is configured in the  
wireless access point (WAP) and any wireless laptop or desktop  
devices. WPA-PSK generates a unique key for each session between a  
wireless client and the associated WAP for more advanced security.  
TWAIN  
XPS  
An industry standard for scanners and software. By using a  
TWAIN-compliant scanner with a TWAIN-compliant program, a scan can  
be initiated from within the program.; an image capture API for Microsoft  
Windows and Apple Macintosh operating systems.  
XML Paper Specification (XPS) is a specification for a Page Description  
Language (PDL) and a new document format, which has benefits for  
portable document and electronic document, developed by Microsoft. It  
is an XML-based specification, based on a new print path and a  
vector-based device-independent document format.  
UNC Path  
Uniform Naming Convention (UNC) is a standard way to access network  
shares in Window NT and other Microsoft products. The format of a  
UNC path is: \\<servername>\<sharename>\<Additional directory>  
URL  
Uniform Resource Locator (URL) is the global address of documents  
and resources on the Internet. The first part of the address indicates  
what protocol to use, the second part specifies the IP address or the  
domain name where the resource is located.  
USB  
Universal Serial Bus (USB) is a standard that was developed by the  
USB Implementers Forum, Inc., to connect computers and peripherals.  
Unlike the parallel port, USB is designed to concurrently connect a  
single computer USB port to multiple peripherals.  
Glossary_ 5  

Whirlpool Acs102pp0 User Manual
Trion Air Boss Dc 4 User Manual
Sanyo Ks2432a User Manual
Samsung Sf 560 User Manual
Panasonic Cw C101mu User Manual
MAYTAG MVWC500VW0 02 User Manual
Lifebreath 155ecm User Manual
LG 27EP950 User Manual
EMERSON RC212 User Manual
DELL C3422WE User Manual